Port to C89.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob818b69cc41d12549923e7678ed49cdea118322cc
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "xsettings.h"
73 #include "xgselect.h"
74 #include "sysselect.h"
76 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
77 #include <X11/Shell.h>
78 #endif
80 #include <unistd.h>
82 #ifdef USE_GTK
83 #include "gtkutil.h"
84 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
85 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
86 #endif
87 #endif
89 #ifdef USE_LUCID
90 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
91 #endif
93 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
94 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
95 #define HACK_EDITRES
96 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
97 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
102 #if defined USE_MOTIF
103 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
104 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
105 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
108 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
111 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
112 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
114 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
115 #ifndef XtNpickTop
116 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
117 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
118 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
119 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
124 #include "widget.h"
125 #ifndef XtNinitialState
126 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
127 #endif
128 #endif
130 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
133 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
134 #endif
136 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
137 #ifdef USE_XIM
138 int use_xim = 1;
139 #else
140 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
141 #endif
145 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
146 start. */
148 static int any_help_event_p;
150 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
151 static Lisp_Object last_window;
153 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
154 use. */
156 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
158 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
159 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
160 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
161 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
163 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
165 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
167 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
169 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
171 static struct {
172 struct frame *f;
173 int eventtype;
174 } pending_event_wait;
176 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
177 /* The application context for Xt use. */
178 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
179 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
181 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
183 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
184 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
186 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
187 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
188 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
190 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
192 /* Mouse movement.
194 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
195 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
196 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
197 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
199 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
201 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
202 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
203 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
204 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
205 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
206 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
207 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
208 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
209 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
210 is off. */
212 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
214 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
215 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
216 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
218 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
220 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
221 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
222 an ordinary motion.
224 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
225 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
226 event. */
228 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
230 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
231 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
232 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
233 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
234 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
235 it's somewhat accurate. */
237 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
239 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
241 static Time last_user_time;
243 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
244 events. */
246 static int volatile input_signal_count;
248 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
250 static int x_noop_count;
252 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
254 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
255 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
257 #ifdef USE_GTK
258 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
259 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
261 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
262 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
263 #endif
265 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
266 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
268 enum xembed_info
270 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
273 enum xembed_message
275 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
276 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
277 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
278 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
280 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
281 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
282 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
284 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
285 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
286 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
287 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
288 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
291 /* Used in x_flush. */
293 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
294 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
295 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
296 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
297 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
298 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
300 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
301 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
302 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
303 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
304 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
305 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
306 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
307 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
308 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
309 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
310 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
311 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
312 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
313 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
314 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
315 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
316 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
317 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
318 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
319 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
320 enum text_cursor_kinds);
322 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
323 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
324 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
325 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
326 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
327 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
328 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
329 enum scroll_bar_part *,
330 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
331 Time *);
332 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
333 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
334 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
335 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
336 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
337 int *, struct input_event *);
338 #ifdef USE_GTK
339 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
340 #endif
341 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
342 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
343 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
344 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
345 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
346 static void x_initialize (void);
349 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
351 static void
352 x_flush (struct frame *f)
354 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
355 connection may be broken. */
356 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
357 return;
359 block_input ();
360 if (f == NULL)
362 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
363 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
364 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
365 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
367 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
368 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
369 unblock_input ();
373 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
374 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
375 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
376 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
377 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
378 performance. */
380 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
383 /***********************************************************************
384 Debugging
385 ***********************************************************************/
387 #if 0
389 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
390 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
392 struct record
394 char *locus;
395 int type;
398 struct record event_record[100];
400 int event_record_index;
402 void
403 record_event (char *locus, int type)
405 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
406 event_record_index = 0;
408 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
409 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
410 event_record_index++;
413 #endif /* 0 */
417 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
419 struct x_display_info *
420 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
422 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
424 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
425 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
426 return dpyinfo;
428 return 0;
431 static Window
432 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
434 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
435 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
436 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
438 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
440 Window root;
441 Window *children;
442 unsigned int nchildren;
444 win = wi;
445 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
446 XFree (children);
449 return win;
452 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
454 void
455 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
458 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
459 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
460 double alpha = 1.0;
461 double alpha_min = 1.0;
462 unsigned long opac;
463 Window parent;
465 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
466 alpha = f->alpha[0];
467 else
468 alpha = f->alpha[1];
470 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
471 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
472 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
473 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
475 if (alpha < 0.0)
476 return;
477 else if (alpha > 1.0)
478 alpha = 1.0;
479 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
480 alpha = alpha_min;
482 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
484 x_catch_errors (dpy);
486 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
487 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
488 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
489 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
491 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
492 if (parent != None)
493 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
494 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
495 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
497 /* return unless necessary */
499 unsigned char *data;
500 Atom actual;
501 int rc, format;
502 unsigned long n, left;
504 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
506 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
507 &data);
509 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
511 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
512 XFree (data);
513 if (value == opac)
515 x_uncatch_errors ();
516 return;
521 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
522 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
523 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
524 x_uncatch_errors ();
528 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
530 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
536 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
540 /***********************************************************************
541 Starting and ending an update
542 ***********************************************************************/
544 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
545 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
546 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
547 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
548 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
550 static void
551 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
553 /* Nothing to do. */
557 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
558 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
559 position of W. */
561 static void
562 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
564 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
565 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
567 updated_window = w;
568 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
570 block_input ();
572 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
574 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
575 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
577 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
578 highlighting. */
579 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
580 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
583 unblock_input ();
587 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
589 static void
590 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
592 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
593 struct face *face;
595 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
596 if (face)
597 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
598 face->foreground);
600 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
601 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
604 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
606 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
607 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
609 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
610 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
611 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
613 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
614 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
615 here. */
617 static void
618 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
620 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
622 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
624 block_input ();
626 if (cursor_on_p)
627 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
628 output_cursor.vpos,
629 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
631 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
632 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
634 unblock_input ();
637 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
638 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
639 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
641 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
642 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
643 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
646 updated_window = NULL;
650 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
651 update_end. */
653 static void
654 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
656 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
657 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
659 #ifndef XFlush
660 block_input ();
661 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
662 unblock_input ();
663 #endif
667 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
668 complete update has been performed. The global variable
669 updated_window is not available here. */
671 static void
672 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
674 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
675 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
679 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
680 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
681 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
682 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
683 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
684 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
686 static void
687 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
689 struct window *w = updated_window;
690 struct frame *f;
691 int width, height;
693 eassert (w);
695 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
696 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
698 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
699 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
700 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
701 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
702 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
703 overhead is very small. */
704 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
705 && desired_row->full_width_p
706 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
707 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
708 width != 0)
709 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
710 height > 0))
712 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
714 block_input ();
715 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
716 0, y, width, height, False);
717 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
718 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
719 y, width, height, False);
720 unblock_input ();
724 static void
725 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
727 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
728 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
729 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
730 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
731 struct face *face = p->face;
733 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
734 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
736 if (!p->overlay_p)
738 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
740 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
741 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
742 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
743 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
744 if (face->stipple)
745 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
746 else
747 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
749 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
750 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
751 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
752 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
753 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
754 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
755 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
756 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
758 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
760 if (sb_width > 0)
762 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
763 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
764 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
766 if (bx < 0)
768 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
769 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
770 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
771 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
772 bx = bar_area_x;
773 if (bx >= 0)
775 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
777 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
778 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
779 row->y));
780 ny = row->visible_height;
783 else
785 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
787 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
790 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
791 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
795 #endif
796 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
797 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
799 if (!face->stipple)
800 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
803 if (p->which)
805 char *bits;
806 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
807 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
808 XGCValues gcv;
810 if (p->wd > 8)
811 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
812 else
813 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
815 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
816 by the server. */
817 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
818 (p->cursor_p
819 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
820 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
821 : face->foreground),
822 face->background, depth);
824 if (p->overlay_p)
826 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
827 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
828 bits, p->wd, p->h,
829 1, 0, 1);
830 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
831 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
832 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
833 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
836 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
837 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
838 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
840 if (p->overlay_p)
842 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
843 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
844 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
848 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
853 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
854 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
855 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
856 rarely happens). */
858 static void
859 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
863 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
864 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
866 static void
867 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
872 /***********************************************************************
873 Glyph display
874 ***********************************************************************/
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
881 int);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
886 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
887 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
891 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
892 unsigned long *, double, int);
893 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
894 double, int, unsigned long);
895 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
898 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
899 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
900 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
901 int, int, int);
902 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, int, int, int,
904 XRectangle *);
905 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
906 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
907 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
909 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
910 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
911 #endif
914 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
915 face. */
917 static void
918 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
920 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
921 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
922 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
923 && !s->cmp)
924 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
925 else
927 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
928 XGCValues xgcv;
929 unsigned long mask;
931 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
932 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
934 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
935 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
936 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
937 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
938 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
939 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
940 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
942 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
943 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
944 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
946 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
947 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
950 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
951 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
952 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
954 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
955 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
956 mask, &xgcv);
957 else
958 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
959 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
961 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
966 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
968 static void
969 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
971 int face_id;
972 struct face *face;
974 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
975 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
976 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
977 if (face == NULL)
978 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
980 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
981 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
982 else
983 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
984 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
985 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
987 if (s->font == s->face->font)
988 s->gc = s->face->gc;
989 else
991 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
992 except for FONT. */
993 XGCValues xgcv;
994 unsigned long mask;
996 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
997 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
998 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
999 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1001 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1002 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1003 mask, &xgcv);
1004 else
1005 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1006 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1008 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1011 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1015 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1016 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1017 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1019 static void
1020 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1022 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1026 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1027 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1028 pattern. */
1030 static void
1031 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1033 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1035 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1037 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1038 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1040 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1042 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1043 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1045 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1047 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1048 s->stippled_p = 0;
1050 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1052 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1053 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1055 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1056 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1058 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1059 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1061 else
1063 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1064 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1067 /* GC must have been set. */
1068 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1072 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1073 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1075 static void
1076 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1078 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1079 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1081 if (n > 0)
1082 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1083 s->num_clips = n;
1087 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1088 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1089 the area of SRC. */
1091 static void
1092 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1094 XRectangle r;
1096 r.x = src->x;
1097 r.width = src->width;
1098 r.y = src->y;
1099 r.height = src->height;
1100 dst->clip[0] = r;
1101 dst->num_clips = 1;
1102 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1106 /* RIF:
1107 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1109 static void
1110 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1112 if (s->cmp == NULL
1113 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1114 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1116 struct font_metrics metrics;
1118 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1120 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1121 struct font *font = s->font;
1122 int i;
1124 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1125 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1126 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1128 else
1130 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1132 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1134 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1135 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1136 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1138 else if (s->cmp)
1140 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1141 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1146 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1148 static void
1149 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1151 XGCValues xgcv;
1152 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1153 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1154 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1155 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1159 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1160 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1161 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1162 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1163 contains the first component of a composition. */
1165 static void
1166 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1168 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1169 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1170 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1172 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1174 if (s->stippled_p)
1176 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1177 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1178 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1179 s->y + box_line_width,
1180 s->background_width,
1181 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1182 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1183 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1185 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1186 || s->font_not_found_p
1187 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1188 || force_p)
1190 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1199 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1201 static void
1202 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1204 int i, x;
1206 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1207 of S to the right of that box line. */
1208 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1209 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1210 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1211 else
1212 x = s->x;
1214 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1215 loaded. */
1216 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1218 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1220 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1221 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1222 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1223 s->height - 1);
1224 x += g->pixel_width;
1227 else
1229 struct font *font = s->font;
1230 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1231 int y;
1233 if (font->vertical_centering)
1234 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1236 y = s->ybase - boff;
1237 if (s->for_overlaps
1238 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1239 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1240 else
1241 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1242 if (s->face->overstrike)
1243 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1247 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1249 static void
1250 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1252 int i, j, x;
1253 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1256 of S to the right of that box line. */
1257 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1258 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1259 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1260 else
1261 x = s->x;
1263 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1264 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1265 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1266 this composition. */
1268 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1269 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1270 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1272 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1274 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1276 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1278 int y = s->ybase;
1280 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1281 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1282 space on the left or right. */
1283 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1285 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1286 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1288 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1289 if (s->face->overstrike)
1290 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1293 else
1295 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1296 Lisp_Object glyph;
1297 int y = s->ybase;
1298 int width = 0;
1300 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1302 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1303 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1304 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1305 else
1307 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1309 if (j < i)
1311 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1312 if (s->face->overstrike)
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1314 x += width;
1316 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1317 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1318 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1319 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1320 if (s->face->overstrike)
1321 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1322 x += wadjust;
1323 j = i + 1;
1324 width = 0;
1327 if (j < i)
1329 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1330 if (s->face->overstrike)
1331 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1337 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1342 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1343 XChar2b char2b[8];
1344 int x, i, j;
1346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1347 of S to the right of that box line. */
1348 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1350 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1351 else
1352 x = s->x;
1354 s->char2b = char2b;
1356 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1358 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1359 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1361 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1363 if (len > 0
1364 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1365 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1366 >= 1))
1368 Lisp_Object acronym
1369 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1370 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1371 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1372 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1373 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1374 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1377 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1379 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1380 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1381 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1382 str = buf;
1385 if (str)
1387 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1388 unsigned code;
1390 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1391 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1393 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1394 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1396 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1397 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1398 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1400 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1401 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1402 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1405 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1406 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1407 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1408 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1409 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1410 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1414 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1416 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1417 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1418 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1419 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1421 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1423 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1424 cannot be determined. */
1426 static struct frame *
1427 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1429 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1430 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1431 struct frame *f;
1433 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1435 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1436 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1437 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1438 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1439 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1440 widget = XtParent (widget);
1442 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1443 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1444 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1446 f = XFRAME (frame);
1447 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1448 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1449 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1450 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1451 return f;
1453 emacs_abort ();
1456 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1457 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1458 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1459 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1460 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1461 Value is true if successful. */
1463 bool
1464 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1465 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1467 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1468 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1471 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1474 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1475 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1477 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1479 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1480 sizeof (Screen *)},
1481 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1482 sizeof (Colormap)}
1486 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1487 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1489 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1492 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1494 DPY is the display we are working on.
1496 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1497 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1498 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1499 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1501 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1502 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1504 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1505 we allocated the color or not.
1507 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1509 static Boolean
1510 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1511 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1512 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1514 Screen *screen;
1515 Colormap cmap;
1516 Pixel pixel;
1517 String color_name;
1518 XColor color;
1520 if (*nargs != 2)
1522 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1523 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1524 "XtToolkitError",
1525 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1526 return False;
1529 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1530 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1531 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1533 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1536 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1538 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1541 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1543 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1544 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1546 pixel = color.pixel;
1547 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1549 else
1551 String params[1];
1552 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1554 params[0] = color_name;
1555 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1556 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1557 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1558 params, &nparams);
1559 return False;
1562 if (to->addr != NULL)
1564 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return False;
1570 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1572 else
1574 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1575 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1578 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1579 return True;
1583 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1584 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1585 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1587 APP is the application context in which we work.
1589 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1590 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1591 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1593 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1595 static void
1596 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1597 Cardinal *nargs)
1599 if (*nargs != 2)
1601 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1602 "XtToolkitError",
1603 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1604 NULL, NULL);
1606 else if (closure != NULL)
1608 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1609 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1610 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1611 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1612 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1617 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1620 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1621 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1622 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1623 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1625 static const XColor *
1626 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1628 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1630 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1632 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1633 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1634 int i;
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1637 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1638 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1640 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1658 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1660 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1662 int i;
1663 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1665 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1666 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1667 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1668 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1671 else
1672 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1677 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1679 void
1680 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1691 static bool
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1694 bool rc;
1696 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1697 if (rc == 0)
1699 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1700 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1701 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1702 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1703 int nearest, i;
1704 int max_color_delta = 255;
1705 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1706 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1707 int ncells;
1708 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1713 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1714 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1715 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 nearest = i;
1720 nearest_delta = delta;
1724 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1725 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1726 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1729 else
1731 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1732 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1733 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1734 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1735 XColor *cached_color;
1737 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1738 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1739 (cached_color->red != color->red
1740 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1741 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1744 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1745 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1749 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1750 if (rc)
1751 register_color (color->pixel);
1752 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754 return rc;
1758 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1759 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1760 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1761 allocated. */
1763 bool
1764 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1766 gamma_correct (f, color);
1767 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1771 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1772 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1773 get color reference counts right. */
1775 unsigned long
1776 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1778 XColor color;
1780 color.pixel = pixel;
1781 block_input ();
1782 x_query_color (f, &color);
1783 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1784 unblock_input ();
1785 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1786 register_color (pixel);
1787 #endif
1788 return color.pixel;
1792 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1793 boosted.
1795 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1796 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1797 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1798 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1799 use an additional additive factor.
1801 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1802 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1803 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1806 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1807 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1808 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1809 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1810 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1811 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1813 static bool
1814 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1816 XColor color, new;
1817 long bright;
1818 bool success_p;
1820 /* Get RGB color values. */
1821 color.pixel = *pixel;
1822 x_query_color (f, &color);
1824 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1825 eassert (factor >= 0);
1826 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1827 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1828 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1830 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1831 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1833 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1834 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1835 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1836 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1837 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1839 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1840 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1841 /* The additive adjustment. */
1842 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1844 if (factor < 1)
1846 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1847 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1848 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1850 else
1852 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1853 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1854 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1858 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1859 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1860 if (success_p)
1862 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1864 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1865 delta to the RGB values. */
1866 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1871 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1873 else
1874 success_p = 1;
1875 *pixel = new.pixel;
1878 return success_p;
1882 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1883 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1884 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1885 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1886 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1887 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1889 static void
1890 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1892 XGCValues xgcv;
1893 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1894 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1895 unsigned long pixel;
1896 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1897 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1898 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1899 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1901 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1902 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1904 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1905 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1906 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1907 if (relief->gc
1908 && relief->allocated_p)
1910 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1911 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1914 /* Allocate new color. */
1915 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1916 pixel = background;
1917 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1918 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1920 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1921 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1924 if (relief->gc == 0)
1926 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1927 mask |= GCStipple;
1928 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1930 else
1931 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1935 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1937 static void
1938 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1940 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long color;
1943 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1944 color = s->face->box_color;
1945 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1946 && s->img->pixmap
1947 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1948 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1949 else
1951 XGCValues xgcv;
1953 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1954 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1955 color = xgcv.background;
1958 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1959 || color != di->relief_background)
1961 di->relief_background = color;
1962 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1963 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1964 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1965 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1970 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1971 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1972 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1973 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1974 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1975 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1976 when drawing. */
1978 static void
1979 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1980 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1981 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1982 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1984 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1985 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1986 int i;
1987 GC gc;
1989 if (raised_p)
1990 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1991 else
1992 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1993 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1995 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1996 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1997 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1998 corner pixels. */
2000 /* Top. */
2001 if (top_p)
2003 if (width == 1)
2004 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2005 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2006 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2008 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2009 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2010 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2011 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2014 /* Left. */
2015 if (left_p)
2017 if (width == 1)
2018 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2020 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2021 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2023 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2024 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2025 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2026 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2029 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2030 if (raised_p)
2031 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2032 else
2033 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2034 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2036 if (width > 1)
2038 /* Outermost top line. */
2039 if (top_p)
2040 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2041 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2042 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2044 /* Outermost left line. */
2045 if (left_p)
2046 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2049 /* Bottom. */
2050 if (bot_p)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2054 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2055 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2057 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2058 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2061 /* Right. */
2062 if (right_p)
2064 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2065 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2069 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2085 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2086 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2088 XGCValues xgcv;
2090 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2091 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2092 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2094 /* Top. */
2095 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2096 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2098 /* Left. */
2099 if (left_p)
2100 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2101 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2103 /* Bottom. */
2104 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2105 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2107 /* Right. */
2108 if (right_p)
2109 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2110 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2112 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2113 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2117 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2119 static void
2120 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2122 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2123 int left_p, right_p;
2124 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2125 XRectangle clip_rect;
2127 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2128 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2129 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2131 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2132 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2133 ? s->first_glyph
2134 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2136 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2137 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2138 left_x = s->x;
2139 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2140 ? last_x - 1
2141 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2142 top_y = s->y;
2143 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2145 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2146 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2147 && (s->prev == NULL
2148 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2149 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2150 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2151 && (s->next == NULL
2152 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2154 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2156 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2157 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2158 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2159 else
2161 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2162 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2163 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2170 static void
2171 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2173 int x = s->x;
2174 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2176 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2177 right of that line. */
2178 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2179 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2180 && s->slice.x == 0)
2181 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2183 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2184 by that margin. */
2185 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2186 x += s->img->hmargin;
2187 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2188 y += s->img->vmargin;
2190 if (s->img->pixmap)
2192 if (s->img->mask)
2194 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2195 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2196 trust on the shape extension to be available
2197 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2198 manually. */
2199 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2200 | GCFunction);
2201 XGCValues xgcv;
2202 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2204 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2205 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2206 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2207 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2208 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2210 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2211 image_rect.x = x;
2212 image_rect.y = y;
2213 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2214 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2215 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2216 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2217 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2218 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2220 else
2222 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2224 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2225 image_rect.x = x;
2226 image_rect.y = y;
2227 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2228 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2229 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2230 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2231 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2232 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2234 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2235 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2236 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2237 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2238 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2239 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2240 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2242 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2243 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2244 x - relief, y - relief,
2245 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2246 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2250 else
2251 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2252 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2253 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2257 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2259 static void
2260 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2262 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2263 XRectangle r;
2264 int x = s->x;
2265 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2267 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2268 right of that line. */
2269 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2270 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2271 && s->slice.x == 0)
2272 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2274 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2275 by that margin. */
2276 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2277 x += s->img->hmargin;
2278 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2279 y += s->img->vmargin;
2281 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2282 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2284 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2285 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2287 else
2289 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2290 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2293 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2294 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2295 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2297 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2298 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2299 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2300 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2301 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2302 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2303 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2304 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2306 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2307 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2308 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2309 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2313 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2315 static void
2316 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2318 int x = 0;
2319 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2321 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2322 right of that line. */
2323 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2324 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2325 && s->slice.x == 0)
2326 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2328 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2329 by that margin. */
2330 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2331 x += s->img->hmargin;
2332 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2333 y += s->img->vmargin;
2335 if (s->img->pixmap)
2337 if (s->img->mask)
2339 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2340 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2341 trust on the shape extension to be available
2342 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2343 manually. */
2344 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2345 | GCFunction);
2346 XGCValues xgcv;
2348 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2349 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2350 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2351 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2352 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2354 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2355 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2356 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2357 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2359 else
2361 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2362 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2363 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2365 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2366 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2367 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2368 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2369 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2370 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2371 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2373 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2374 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2375 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2376 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2380 else
2381 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2382 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2383 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2387 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2388 give the rectangle to draw. */
2390 static void
2391 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2393 if (s->stippled_p)
2395 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2396 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2397 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2398 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2400 else
2401 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2405 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2407 s->y
2408 s->x +-------------------------
2409 | s->face->box
2411 | +-------------------------
2412 | | s->img->margin
2414 | | +-------------------
2415 | | | the image
2419 static void
2420 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2422 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2423 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2424 int height;
2425 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2427 height = s->height;
2428 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2429 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2430 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2431 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2433 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2434 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2435 flickering. */
2436 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2437 if (height > s->slice.height
2438 || s->img->hmargin
2439 || s->img->vmargin
2440 || s->img->mask
2441 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2442 || s->width != s->background_width)
2444 if (s->img->mask)
2446 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2447 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2448 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2449 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2450 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2452 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2453 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2454 s->background_width,
2455 s->height, depth);
2457 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2458 pixmap. */
2459 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2461 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2462 if (s->stippled_p)
2464 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2465 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2466 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2467 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2468 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2469 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2470 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2472 else
2474 XGCValues xgcv;
2475 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2476 &xgcv);
2477 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2478 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2479 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2480 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2483 else
2485 int x = s->x;
2486 int y = s->y;
2488 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2489 && s->slice.x == 0)
2490 x += box_line_hwidth;
2492 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2493 y += box_line_vwidth;
2495 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2498 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2501 /* Draw the foreground. */
2502 if (pixmap != None)
2504 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2505 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2506 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2507 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2508 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2510 else
2511 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2513 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2514 if (s->img->relief
2515 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2516 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2517 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2521 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2523 static void
2524 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2526 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2528 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2529 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2531 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2532 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2533 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2534 int x = s->x;
2536 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2538 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2540 if (x < left_x)
2542 background_width -= left_x - x;
2543 x = left_x;
2546 else
2548 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2549 stretch glyph. */
2550 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2552 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2553 background_width -= x - right_x;
2554 x += background_width;
2556 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2557 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2558 x -= width;
2560 /* Draw cursor. */
2561 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2563 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2564 if (width < background_width)
2566 int y = s->y;
2567 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2568 XRectangle r;
2569 GC gc;
2571 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2572 x += width;
2573 else
2574 x = s->x;
2575 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2576 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2578 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2579 gc = s->gc;
2581 else
2582 gc = s->face->gc;
2584 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2585 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2587 if (s->face->stipple)
2589 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2590 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2591 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2592 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2594 else
2596 XGCValues xgcv;
2597 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2598 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2599 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2600 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2604 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2606 int background_width = s->background_width;
2607 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2609 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2610 except for header line and mode line. */
2611 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2613 background_width -= left_x - x;
2614 x = left_x;
2616 if (background_width > 0)
2617 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2620 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2624 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2626 x0 wave_length = 2
2628 y0 * * * * *
2629 |* * * * * * * * *
2630 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2634 static void
2635 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2637 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2638 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2639 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2641 dx = wave_length;
2642 dy = wave_height - 1;
2643 x0 = s->x;
2644 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2645 width = s->width;
2646 xmax = x0 + width;
2648 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2650 wave_clip.x = x0;
2651 wave_clip.y = y0;
2652 wave_clip.width = width;
2653 wave_clip.height = wave_height;
2654 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2656 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2657 return;
2659 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2661 /* Draw the waves */
2663 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2664 x2 = x1 + dx;
2665 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2666 y1 = y2 = y0;
2668 if (odd)
2669 y1 += dy;
2670 else
2671 y2 += dy;
2673 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2674 emacs_abort ();
2676 while (x1 <= xmax)
2678 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2679 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2680 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2681 odd = !odd;
2684 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2685 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2689 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2691 static void
2692 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2694 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2696 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2697 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2698 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2699 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2701 int width;
2702 struct glyph_string *next;
2704 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2705 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2706 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2707 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2709 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2710 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2711 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2712 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2713 else
2714 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2715 next->num_clips = 0;
2719 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2720 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2722 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2723 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2724 if (!s->for_overlaps
2725 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2726 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2727 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2730 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2731 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2732 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2733 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2734 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2736 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2737 && !s->clip_tail
2738 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2739 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2740 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2741 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2742 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2744 else
2745 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2747 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2749 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2750 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2751 break;
2753 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2754 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2755 break;
2757 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2758 if (s->for_overlaps)
2759 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2760 else
2761 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2762 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2763 break;
2765 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2766 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2767 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2768 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2769 else
2770 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2771 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2772 break;
2774 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2775 if (s->for_overlaps)
2776 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2777 else
2778 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2779 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2780 break;
2782 default:
2783 emacs_abort ();
2786 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2788 /* Draw underline. */
2789 if (s->face->underline_p)
2791 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2793 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2794 x_draw_underwave (s);
2795 else
2797 XGCValues xgcv;
2798 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2799 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2800 x_draw_underwave (s);
2801 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2804 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2806 unsigned long thickness, position;
2807 int y;
2809 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2810 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2812 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2813 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2814 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2816 else
2818 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2819 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2820 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2821 else
2822 thickness = 1;
2823 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2824 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2825 else
2827 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2828 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2829 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2830 specs, and its default is
2832 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2833 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2835 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2836 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2837 position = s->font->underline_position;
2838 else if (s->font)
2839 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2840 else
2841 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2843 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2845 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2846 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2847 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2848 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2849 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2850 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2851 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2852 s->underline_position = position;
2853 y = s->ybase + position;
2854 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2855 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2856 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2857 else
2859 XGCValues xgcv;
2860 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2861 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2862 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2863 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2864 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2868 /* Draw overline. */
2869 if (s->face->overline_p)
2871 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2873 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2874 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2875 s->width, h);
2876 else
2878 XGCValues xgcv;
2879 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2880 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2881 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2882 s->width, h);
2883 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2887 /* Draw strike-through. */
2888 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2890 unsigned long h = 1;
2891 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2893 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2895 s->width, h);
2896 else
2898 XGCValues xgcv;
2899 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2900 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2901 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2902 s->width, h);
2903 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2907 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2908 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2909 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2911 if (s->prev)
2913 struct glyph_string *prev;
2915 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2916 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2917 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2919 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2920 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2921 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2923 prev->hl = s->hl;
2924 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2925 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2926 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2927 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2928 else
2929 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2930 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2931 prev->hl = save;
2932 prev->num_clips = 0;
2936 if (s->next)
2938 struct glyph_string *next;
2940 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2941 if (next->hl != s->hl
2942 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2944 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2945 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2946 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2948 next->hl = s->hl;
2949 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2950 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2951 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2952 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2953 else
2954 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2955 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2956 next->hl = save;
2957 next->num_clips = 0;
2958 next->clip_head = s->next;
2963 /* Reset clipping. */
2964 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2965 s->num_clips = 0;
2968 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2970 static void
2971 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2973 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2974 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2975 x, y, width, height,
2976 x + shift_by, y);
2979 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2980 for X frames. */
2982 static void
2983 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2985 emacs_abort ();
2989 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2990 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2992 void
2993 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2995 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2996 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3000 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3002 static void
3003 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3005 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3006 longer visible. */
3007 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3008 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3009 output_cursor.x = -1;
3011 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3012 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3013 block_input ();
3015 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3017 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3018 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3019 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3021 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3022 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3023 redisplay, do it here. */
3024 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3025 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3026 #endif
3028 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3030 unblock_input ();
3035 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3037 static void
3038 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3040 block_input ();
3043 #ifdef USE_GTK
3044 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3045 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3046 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3047 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3048 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3049 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3050 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3051 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3052 do { \
3053 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3054 cairo_fill (cr); \
3056 while (0)
3057 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3058 GdkGCValues vals;
3059 GdkGC *gc;
3060 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3061 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3062 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3063 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3064 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3065 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3066 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3067 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3068 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3069 GC gc;
3071 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3072 pixels into background pixels. */
3074 XGCValues values;
3076 values.function = GXxor;
3077 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3078 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3080 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3081 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3083 #endif
3085 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3086 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3087 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3088 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3089 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3090 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3091 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3093 int width;
3095 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3096 edge it is next to. */
3097 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3099 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3100 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3101 break;
3103 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3104 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3105 break;
3107 default:
3108 break;
3111 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3113 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3114 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3116 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3117 flash_left,
3118 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3119 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3120 width, flash_height);
3121 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3122 flash_left,
3123 (height - flash_height
3124 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3125 width, flash_height);
3128 else
3129 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3130 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3131 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3132 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3134 x_flush (f);
3137 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3138 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3140 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3141 available. */
3142 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3144 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3145 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3147 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3148 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3149 break;
3151 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3152 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3154 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3155 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3159 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3160 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3162 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3163 flash_left,
3164 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3165 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3166 width, flash_height);
3167 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3168 flash_left,
3169 (height - flash_height
3170 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3171 width, flash_height);
3173 else
3174 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3175 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3176 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3177 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3179 #ifdef USE_GTK
3180 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3181 cairo_destroy (cr);
3182 #else
3183 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3184 #endif
3185 #undef XFillRectangle
3186 #else
3187 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3188 #endif
3189 x_flush (f);
3193 unblock_input ();
3197 static void
3198 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3200 block_input ();
3201 if (invisible)
3203 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3204 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3205 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3207 else
3208 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3209 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3210 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3211 unblock_input ();
3215 /* Make audible bell. */
3217 static void
3218 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3220 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3222 if (visible_bell)
3223 XTflash (f);
3224 else
3226 block_input ();
3227 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
3228 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
3229 #else
3230 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3231 #endif
3232 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3233 unblock_input ();
3239 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3240 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3241 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3242 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3244 static void
3245 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3247 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3252 /***********************************************************************
3253 Line Dance
3254 ***********************************************************************/
3256 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3257 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3259 static void
3260 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3262 emacs_abort ();
3266 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3268 static void
3269 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3271 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3272 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3274 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3275 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3276 fringe of W. */
3277 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3279 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3280 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3281 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3282 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3283 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3284 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3285 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3286 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3288 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3290 if (sb_width > 0)
3292 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3293 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3294 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3296 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3298 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3299 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3301 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3302 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3305 #endif
3307 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3308 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3309 bottom_y = y + height;
3311 if (to_y < from_y)
3313 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3314 line at the bottom. */
3315 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3316 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3317 else
3318 height = run->height;
3320 else
3322 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3323 at the bottom. */
3324 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3325 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3326 else
3327 height = run->height;
3330 block_input ();
3332 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3333 updated_window = w;
3334 x_clear_cursor (w);
3336 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3337 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3338 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3339 x, from_y,
3340 width, height,
3341 x, to_y);
3343 unblock_input ();
3348 /***********************************************************************
3349 Exposure Events
3350 ***********************************************************************/
3353 static void
3354 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3356 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3357 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3358 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3359 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3360 block_input ();
3361 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3362 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3363 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3364 because of this (bug#9310). */
3365 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3366 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3367 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3368 x_uncatch_errors ();
3369 unblock_input ();
3370 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3371 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3374 static void
3375 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3377 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3378 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3379 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3380 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3381 block_input ();
3382 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3383 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3384 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3385 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3386 x_uncatch_errors ();
3387 unblock_input ();
3388 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3389 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3392 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3393 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3394 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3395 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3396 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3398 static void
3399 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3401 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3403 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3405 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3406 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3407 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3409 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3410 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3412 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3413 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3414 else
3415 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3418 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3421 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3422 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3423 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3425 static void
3426 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3428 if (type == FocusIn)
3430 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3432 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3433 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3435 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3436 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3437 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3438 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3439 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3440 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3442 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3443 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3447 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3449 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3450 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3451 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3452 #endif
3454 else if (type == FocusOut)
3456 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3458 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3460 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3461 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3464 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3465 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3466 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3467 #endif
3468 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3469 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3473 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3474 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3476 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3478 static void
3479 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3481 struct frame *frame;
3483 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3484 if (! frame)
3485 return;
3487 switch (event->type)
3489 case EnterNotify:
3490 case LeaveNotify:
3492 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3493 int focus_state
3494 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3496 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3497 && event->xcrossing.focus
3498 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3499 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3500 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3501 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3503 break;
3505 case FocusIn:
3506 case FocusOut:
3507 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3508 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3509 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3510 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3511 break;
3513 case ClientMessage:
3514 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3516 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3517 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3518 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3520 break;
3525 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3526 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3528 void
3529 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3531 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3533 #endif
3535 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3536 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3537 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3539 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3540 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3541 the appropriate X display info. */
3543 static void
3544 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3546 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3549 static void
3550 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3552 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3554 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3556 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3557 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3558 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3559 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3560 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3562 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3566 else
3567 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3569 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3571 if (old_highlight)
3572 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3573 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3574 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3580 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3582 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3583 static void
3584 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3586 int min_code, max_code;
3587 KeySym *syms;
3588 int syms_per_code;
3589 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3591 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3592 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3593 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3594 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3595 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3597 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3599 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3600 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3601 &syms_per_code);
3602 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3604 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3605 Alt keysyms are on. */
3607 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3608 int found_alt_or_meta;
3610 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3612 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3613 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3615 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3617 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3618 if (code == 0)
3619 continue;
3621 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3623 int code_col;
3625 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3627 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3629 switch (sym)
3631 case XK_Meta_L:
3632 case XK_Meta_R:
3633 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3634 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3635 break;
3637 case XK_Alt_L:
3638 case XK_Alt_R:
3639 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3640 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3641 break;
3643 case XK_Hyper_L:
3644 case XK_Hyper_R:
3645 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3646 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3647 code_col = syms_per_code;
3648 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3649 break;
3651 case XK_Super_L:
3652 case XK_Super_R:
3653 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3654 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3655 code_col = syms_per_code;
3656 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3657 break;
3659 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3660 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3661 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3662 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3663 code_col = syms_per_code;
3664 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3665 break;
3673 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3674 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3676 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3677 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3680 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3681 make them just meta, not alt. */
3682 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3684 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3687 XFree (syms);
3688 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3691 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3692 Emacs uses. */
3695 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3697 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3698 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3699 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3700 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3701 Lisp_Object tem;
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3708 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3709 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3710 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3712 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3713 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3715 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3716 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3717 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3720 static int
3721 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3723 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3724 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3725 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3726 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3728 Lisp_Object tem;
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3734 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3735 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3736 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3737 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3740 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3741 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3742 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3743 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3744 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3745 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3748 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3750 char *
3751 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3753 char *value;
3755 block_input ();
3756 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3757 unblock_input ();
3759 return value;
3764 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3766 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3768 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3769 the mouse. */
3771 static Lisp_Object
3772 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3774 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3775 otherwise. */
3776 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3777 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3778 result->timestamp = event->time;
3779 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3780 event->state)
3781 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3782 ? up_modifier
3783 : down_modifier));
3785 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3786 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3787 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3788 result->arg = Qnil;
3789 return Qnil;
3793 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3794 The input handler calls this.
3796 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3797 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3798 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3799 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3801 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3802 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3804 static int
3805 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3807 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3808 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3809 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3811 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3812 return 0;
3814 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3816 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3817 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3818 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3819 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3820 return 1;
3824 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3825 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3826 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3827 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3828 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3829 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3831 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3832 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3833 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3834 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3835 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3836 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3837 return 1;
3840 return 0;
3844 /************************************************************************
3845 Mouse Face
3846 ************************************************************************/
3848 static void
3849 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3851 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3852 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3853 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3854 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3855 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3860 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3861 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3863 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3864 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3865 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3866 position on the scroll bar.
3868 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3869 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3870 the mouse is over.
3872 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3873 was at this position.
3875 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3877 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3878 movement. */
3880 static void
3881 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3882 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3883 Time *timestamp)
3885 FRAME_PTR f1;
3887 block_input ();
3889 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3890 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3891 else
3893 Window root;
3894 int root_x, root_y;
3896 Window dummy_window;
3897 int dummy;
3899 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3901 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3902 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3903 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3904 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3905 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3907 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3909 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3910 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3911 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3913 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3914 &root,
3916 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3917 a different screen. */
3918 &dummy_window,
3920 /* The position on that root window. */
3921 &root_x, &root_y,
3923 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3924 &dummy, &dummy,
3926 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3927 we don't care. */
3928 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3930 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3931 containing the pointer. */
3933 Window win, child;
3934 int win_x, win_y;
3935 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3937 win = root;
3939 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3940 structure is changing at the same time this function
3941 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3943 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3946 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3948 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3949 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3950 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3952 /* From-window, to-window. */
3953 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3955 /* From-position, to-position. */
3956 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3958 /* Child of win. */
3959 &child);
3960 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3962 else
3964 while (1)
3966 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3968 /* From-window, to-window. */
3969 root, win,
3971 /* From-position, to-position. */
3972 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3974 /* Child of win. */
3975 &child);
3977 if (child == None || child == win)
3978 break;
3979 #ifdef USE_GTK
3980 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3981 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3982 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3983 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3984 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3985 break;
3986 #endif
3987 win = child;
3988 parent_x = win_x;
3989 parent_y = win_y;
3992 /* Now we know that:
3993 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3994 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3995 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3996 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3997 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3998 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3999 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4000 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4001 never use them in that case.) */
4003 #ifdef USE_GTK
4004 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4005 want the edit window. */
4006 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4007 #else
4008 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4009 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4010 #endif
4012 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4013 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4014 on the frame. */
4015 if (f1 != NULL
4016 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4017 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4018 f1 = NULL;
4019 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4022 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4023 f1 = 0;
4025 x_uncatch_errors ();
4027 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4028 if (! f1)
4030 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4032 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4034 if (bar)
4036 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4037 win_x = parent_x;
4038 win_y = parent_y;
4042 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4043 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4045 if (f1)
4047 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4048 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4049 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4050 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4051 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4052 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4053 the frame are divided into. */
4055 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4056 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4058 *bar_window = Qnil;
4059 *part = 0;
4060 *fp = f1;
4061 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4062 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4063 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4068 unblock_input ();
4073 /***********************************************************************
4074 Scroll bars
4075 ***********************************************************************/
4077 /* Scroll bar support. */
4079 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4080 manages it.
4081 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4082 bits. */
4084 static struct scroll_bar *
4085 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4087 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4089 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4090 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4091 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4093 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4095 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4097 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4098 continue;
4100 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4101 right window ID. */
4102 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4103 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4104 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4105 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4106 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4107 condemned = Qnil,
4108 ! NILP (bar));
4109 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4110 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4111 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4112 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4115 return NULL;
4119 #if defined USE_LUCID
4121 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4122 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4124 static Widget
4125 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4127 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4129 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4130 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4132 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4134 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4135 return menu_bar;
4137 return NULL;
4140 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4143 /************************************************************************
4144 Toolkit scroll bars
4145 ************************************************************************/
4147 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4149 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4150 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4151 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4152 struct scroll_bar *);
4153 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4154 int, int, int);
4157 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4158 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4160 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4162 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4164 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4166 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4167 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4169 #ifndef USE_GTK
4170 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4172 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4174 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4176 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4177 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4178 to avoid jerkiness. */
4180 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4182 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4183 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4184 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4185 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4187 static void
4188 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4189 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4191 int scroll_bar_p;
4192 const char *end_action;
4194 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4195 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4196 end_action = "Release";
4197 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4198 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4199 end_action = "EndScroll";
4200 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4202 if (scroll_bar_p
4203 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4204 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4206 struct window *w;
4208 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4209 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4210 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4212 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4214 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4215 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4216 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4218 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4219 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4221 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4222 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4225 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4227 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4228 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4230 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4231 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4234 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4235 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4236 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4237 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4239 static void
4240 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4242 XEvent event;
4243 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4244 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4245 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4246 ptrdiff_t i;
4248 block_input ();
4250 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4251 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4252 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4253 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4254 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4255 ev->format = 32;
4257 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4258 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4259 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4260 into that array in the event. */
4261 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4262 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4263 break;
4265 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4267 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4268 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4269 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4270 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4271 scroll_bar_windows =
4272 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4273 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4274 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4275 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4278 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4279 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4280 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4281 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4282 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4283 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4285 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4286 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4287 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4288 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4289 #endif
4291 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4292 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4293 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4294 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4295 unblock_input ();
4299 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4300 in *IEVENT. */
4302 static void
4303 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4305 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4306 Lisp_Object window;
4307 struct window *w;
4309 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4310 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4312 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4314 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4315 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4316 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4317 #ifdef USE_GTK
4318 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4319 #else
4320 ievent->timestamp =
4321 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4322 #endif
4323 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4324 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4325 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4326 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4327 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4331 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4333 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4335 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4338 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4339 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4340 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4342 static void
4343 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4345 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4346 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4347 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4349 switch (cs->reason)
4351 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4354 break;
4356 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4359 break;
4361 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4364 break;
4366 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4369 break;
4371 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4372 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4373 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4374 break;
4376 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4377 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4378 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4379 break;
4381 case XmCR_DRAG:
4383 int slider_size;
4385 /* Get the slider size. */
4386 block_input ();
4387 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4388 unblock_input ();
4390 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4391 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4392 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4393 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4395 break;
4397 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4398 break;
4401 if (part >= 0)
4403 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4404 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4405 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4409 #elif defined USE_GTK
4411 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4412 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4414 static gboolean
4415 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4416 GtkScrollType scroll,
4417 gdouble value,
4418 gpointer user_data)
4420 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4421 gdouble position;
4422 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4423 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4424 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4426 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4427 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4430 switch (scroll)
4432 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4433 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4434 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4435 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4437 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4438 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4439 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4440 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4441 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4443 break;
4444 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4445 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4446 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4447 break;
4448 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4449 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4450 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4451 break;
4452 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4453 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4454 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4455 break;
4456 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4457 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4458 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4459 break;
4462 if (part >= 0)
4464 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4465 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4466 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4469 return FALSE;
4472 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4474 static gboolean
4475 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4476 GdkEventButton *event,
4477 gpointer user_data)
4479 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4480 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4481 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4483 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4484 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4485 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4488 return FALSE;
4492 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4494 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4495 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4496 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4497 the thumb is. */
4499 static void
4500 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4502 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4503 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4504 float shown;
4505 int whole, portion, height;
4506 int part;
4508 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4509 block_input ();
4510 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4511 unblock_input ();
4513 whole = 10000000;
4514 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4516 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4517 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4518 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4519 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4520 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4521 bottom). */
4522 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4523 else
4524 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4526 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4527 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4528 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4529 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4533 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4534 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4535 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4536 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4537 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4538 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4539 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4541 static void
4542 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4544 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4545 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4546 int position = (long) call_data;
4547 Dimension height;
4548 int part;
4550 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4551 block_input ();
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4553 unblock_input ();
4555 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4556 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4558 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4559 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4560 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4561 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4562 else
4563 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4565 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4566 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4567 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4568 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4571 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4573 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4575 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4576 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4578 #ifdef USE_GTK
4579 static void
4580 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4582 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4584 block_input ();
4585 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4586 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4587 scroll_bar_name);
4588 unblock_input ();
4591 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4593 static void
4594 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4596 Window xwindow;
4597 Widget widget;
4598 Arg av[20];
4599 int ac = 0;
4600 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4601 unsigned long pixel;
4603 block_input ();
4605 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4606 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4610 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4611 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4612 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4615 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4616 if (pixel != -1)
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4619 ++ac;
4622 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4623 if (pixel != -1)
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4626 ++ac;
4629 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4630 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4632 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4637 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4638 (XtPointer) bar);
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4645 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4646 (XtPointer) bar);
4648 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4649 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4651 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4652 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4653 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4654 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4656 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4658 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4659 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4660 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4661 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4662 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4663 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4664 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4665 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4667 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4668 if (pixel != -1)
4670 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4671 ++ac;
4674 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4675 if (pixel != -1)
4677 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4678 ++ac;
4681 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4683 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4684 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4686 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4687 if (pixel != -1)
4689 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4690 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4691 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4692 pixel = -1;
4693 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4696 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4698 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4699 if (pixel != -1)
4701 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4702 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4703 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4704 pixel = -1;
4705 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4709 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4710 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4711 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4712 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4713 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4714 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4715 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4716 colors itself. */
4718 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4719 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4720 ++ac;
4722 else
4723 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4724 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4725 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4727 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4728 the shadows. */
4729 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4730 ++ac;
4732 /* Specify the colors. */
4733 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4734 if (pixel != -1)
4736 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4737 ++ac;
4739 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4740 if (pixel != -1)
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4743 ++ac;
4746 #endif
4748 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4749 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4752 char const *initial = "";
4753 char const *val = initial;
4754 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4755 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4756 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4757 #endif
4758 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4759 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4760 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4761 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4762 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4763 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4767 /* Define callbacks. */
4768 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4769 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4770 (XtPointer) bar);
4772 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4773 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4775 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4777 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4778 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4779 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4780 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4782 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4783 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4784 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4785 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4787 unblock_input ();
4789 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4792 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4793 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4795 #ifdef USE_GTK
4796 static void
4797 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4799 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4802 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4803 static void
4804 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4805 int whole)
4807 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4808 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4809 float top, shown;
4811 block_input ();
4813 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4815 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
4817 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4818 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4819 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4820 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4821 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4822 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4823 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4824 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4825 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4826 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4827 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4828 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4829 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4830 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4831 whole += portion;
4834 if (whole <= 0)
4835 top = 0, shown = 1;
4836 else
4838 top = (float) position / whole;
4839 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4842 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4844 int size, value;
4846 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4847 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4848 value. */
4849 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4851 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4852 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4853 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4855 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4857 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4859 if (whole == 0)
4860 top = 0, shown = 1;
4861 else
4863 top = (float) position / whole;
4864 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4868 float old_top, old_shown;
4869 Dimension height;
4870 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4871 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4872 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4873 XtNheight, &height,
4874 NULL);
4876 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4877 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4878 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4879 else
4880 top = old_top;
4881 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4882 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4884 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4885 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4886 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4887 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4889 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4890 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4891 else
4893 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4894 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4895 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4897 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4901 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4903 unblock_input ();
4905 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4907 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4911 /************************************************************************
4912 Scroll bars, general
4913 ************************************************************************/
4915 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4916 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4917 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4918 scroll bar. */
4920 static struct scroll_bar *
4921 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4923 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4924 struct scroll_bar *bar
4925 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4926 Lisp_Object barobj;
4928 block_input ();
4930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4931 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4932 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4934 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4935 unsigned long mask;
4936 Window window;
4938 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4939 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4940 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4942 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4943 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4944 | ExposureMask);
4945 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4947 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4949 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4950 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4951 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4952 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4953 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4954 left, top, width,
4955 window_box_height (w), False);
4957 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4958 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4959 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4960 top,
4961 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4962 height,
4963 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4965 CopyFromParent,
4966 CopyFromParent,
4967 CopyFromParent,
4968 /* Attributes. */
4969 mask, &a);
4970 bar->x_window = window;
4972 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4974 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4975 bar->top = top;
4976 bar->left = left;
4977 bar->width = width;
4978 bar->height = height;
4979 bar->start = 0;
4980 bar->end = 0;
4981 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4982 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4984 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4985 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4986 bar->prev = Qnil;
4987 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4988 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4989 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4990 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4992 /* Map the window/widget. */
4993 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4995 #ifdef USE_GTK
4996 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4997 bar->x_window,
4998 top,
4999 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5000 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5001 max (height, 1));
5002 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5003 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5004 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5005 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5006 top,
5007 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5008 max (height, 1), 0);
5009 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5010 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5012 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5013 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5014 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5016 unblock_input ();
5017 return bar;
5021 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5023 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5025 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5026 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5027 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5028 events.)
5030 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5031 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5032 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5033 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5034 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5036 static void
5037 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5039 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5040 Window w = bar->x_window;
5041 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5042 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5044 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5045 if (! rebuild
5046 && start == bar->start
5047 && end == bar->end)
5048 return;
5050 block_input ();
5053 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5054 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5055 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5057 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5058 the distance between start and end. */
5060 int length = end - start;
5062 if (start < 0)
5063 start = 0;
5064 else if (start > top_range)
5065 start = top_range;
5066 end = start + length;
5068 if (end < start)
5069 end = start;
5070 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5071 end = top_range;
5074 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5075 bar->start = start;
5076 bar->end = end;
5078 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5079 if (end > top_range)
5080 end = top_range;
5082 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5083 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5084 that many pixels tall. */
5085 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5087 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5088 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5089 if (start > 0)
5090 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5091 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5092 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5093 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5094 inside_width, start,
5095 False);
5097 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5098 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5099 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5100 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5102 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5103 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5104 /* x, y, width, height */
5105 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5106 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5107 inside_width, end - start);
5109 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5110 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5111 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5112 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5114 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5115 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5116 if (end < inside_height)
5117 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5118 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5119 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5120 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5121 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5122 False);
5126 unblock_input ();
5129 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5131 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5132 nil. */
5134 static void
5135 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5137 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5138 block_input ();
5140 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5141 #ifdef USE_GTK
5142 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5143 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5144 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5145 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5146 #else
5147 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5148 #endif
5150 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5151 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5153 unblock_input ();
5157 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5158 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5159 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5160 create one. */
5162 static void
5163 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5165 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5166 Lisp_Object barobj;
5167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5168 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5169 int window_y, window_height;
5170 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5171 int fringe_extended_p;
5172 #endif
5174 /* Get window dimensions. */
5175 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5176 top = window_y;
5177 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5178 height = window_height;
5180 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5181 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5183 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5184 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5185 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5186 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5187 else
5188 sb_width = width;
5190 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5191 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5192 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5193 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5194 else
5195 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5196 #else
5197 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5198 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5199 else
5200 sb_left = left;
5201 #endif
5203 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5204 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5205 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5206 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5207 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5208 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5209 else
5210 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5211 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5212 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5213 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5214 #endif
5216 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5217 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5219 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5221 block_input ();
5222 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5223 if (fringe_extended_p)
5224 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5225 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5226 else
5227 #endif
5228 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5229 left, top, width, height, False);
5230 unblock_input ();
5233 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5235 else
5237 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5238 unsigned int mask = 0;
5240 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5242 block_input ();
5244 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5245 mask |= CWX;
5246 if (top != bar->top)
5247 mask |= CWY;
5248 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5249 mask |= CWWidth;
5250 if (height != bar->height)
5251 mask |= CWHeight;
5253 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5255 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5256 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5258 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5259 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5260 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5262 if (fringe_extended_p)
5263 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5264 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5265 else
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5267 left, top, width, height, False);
5269 #ifdef USE_GTK
5270 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5271 bar->x_window,
5272 top,
5273 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5274 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5275 max (height, 1));
5276 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5277 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5278 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5279 top,
5280 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5281 max (height, 1), 0);
5282 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5284 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5286 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5287 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5288 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5290 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5291 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5292 height, False);
5293 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5294 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5295 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5296 height, False);
5299 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5300 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5301 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5302 example. */
5304 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5305 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5306 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5308 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5309 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5310 left + area_width - rest, top,
5311 rest, height, False);
5312 else
5313 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5314 left, top, rest, height, False);
5318 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5319 if (mask)
5321 XWindowChanges wc;
5323 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5324 wc.y = top;
5325 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5326 wc.height = height;
5327 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5328 mask, &wc);
5331 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5333 /* Remember new settings. */
5334 bar->left = sb_left;
5335 bar->top = top;
5336 bar->width = sb_width;
5337 bar->height = height;
5339 unblock_input ();
5342 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5343 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5345 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5346 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5347 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5348 dragged. */
5349 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5351 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5353 if (whole == 0)
5354 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5355 else
5357 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5358 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5359 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5362 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5364 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5365 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5369 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5370 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5371 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5372 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5373 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5374 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5375 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5377 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5378 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5379 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5381 static void
5382 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5384 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5385 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5387 Lisp_Object bar;
5388 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5389 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5390 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5391 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5392 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5393 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5394 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5399 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5400 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5402 static void
5403 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5406 struct frame *f;
5407 Lisp_Object barobj;
5409 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5410 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5411 emacs_abort ();
5413 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5415 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5416 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5417 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5419 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5420 the lists. */
5421 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5422 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5423 return;
5424 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5425 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5426 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5427 else
5428 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5429 one or the other! */
5430 emacs_abort ();
5432 else
5433 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5435 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5436 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5438 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5439 bar->prev = Qnil;
5440 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5441 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5442 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5443 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5446 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5447 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5449 static void
5450 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5452 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5454 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5456 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5457 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5458 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5460 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5462 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5464 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5466 next = b->next;
5467 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5470 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5471 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5475 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5476 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5477 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5479 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5480 mark bits. */
5482 static void
5483 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5485 Window w = bar->x_window;
5486 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5487 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5488 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5490 block_input ();
5492 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5494 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5495 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5496 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5497 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5499 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5500 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5502 /* x, y, width, height */
5503 0, 0,
5504 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5505 bar->height - 1);
5507 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5508 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5509 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5510 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5512 unblock_input ();
5515 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5517 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5518 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5520 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5521 mark bits. */
5524 static void
5525 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5527 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5528 emacs_abort ();
5530 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5531 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5532 emacs_event->modifiers
5533 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5534 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5535 event->xbutton.state)
5536 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5537 ? up_modifier
5538 : down_modifier));
5539 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5540 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5541 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5543 int top_range
5544 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5545 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5547 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5548 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5550 if (y < bar->start)
5551 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5552 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5553 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5554 else
5555 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5557 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5558 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5559 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5560 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5562 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5563 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5565 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5566 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5568 #endif
5570 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5571 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5575 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5577 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5579 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5580 mark bits. */
5582 static void
5583 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5585 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5587 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5589 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5590 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5592 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5593 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5595 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5596 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5598 if (new_start != bar->start)
5600 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5602 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5607 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5609 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5610 on the scroll bar. */
5612 static void
5613 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5614 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5615 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5617 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5618 Window w = bar->x_window;
5619 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5620 int win_x, win_y;
5621 Window dummy_window;
5622 int dummy_coord;
5623 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5625 block_input ();
5627 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5628 report that. */
5629 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5631 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5632 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5633 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5635 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5636 &win_x, &win_y,
5638 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5639 &dummy_mask))
5641 else
5643 int top_range
5644 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5646 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5648 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5649 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5651 if (win_y < 0)
5652 win_y = 0;
5653 if (win_y > top_range)
5654 win_y = top_range;
5656 *fp = f;
5657 *bar_window = bar->window;
5659 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5660 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5661 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5662 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5663 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5664 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5665 else
5666 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5668 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5669 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5671 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5672 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5675 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5677 unblock_input ();
5681 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5682 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5683 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5684 redraw them. */
5686 static void
5687 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5689 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5690 Lisp_Object bar;
5692 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5693 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5694 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5695 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5696 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5697 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5698 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5699 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5700 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5701 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5705 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5707 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5708 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5709 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5710 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5712 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5713 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5715 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5717 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5718 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5720 static int temp_index;
5721 static short temp_buffer[100];
5723 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5724 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5725 temp_index = 0; \
5726 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5728 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5729 on a particular display. */
5731 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5733 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5734 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5735 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5736 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5738 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5740 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5741 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5742 do \
5744 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5745 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5746 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5747 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5748 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5749 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5751 while (0)
5752 #endif
5754 enum
5756 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5757 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5758 X_EVENT_DROP
5761 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5762 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5763 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5765 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5766 this event further.
5767 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5769 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5770 static int
5771 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5773 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5774 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5775 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5776 was created. */
5778 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5779 event->xclient.window);
5781 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5783 #endif
5785 #ifdef USE_GTK
5786 static int current_count;
5787 static int current_finish;
5788 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5790 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5791 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5792 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5793 static GdkFilterReturn
5794 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5796 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5798 block_input ();
5799 if (current_count >= 0)
5801 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5803 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5805 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5806 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5807 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5808 so we do it here. */
5809 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5810 && dpyinfo
5811 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5813 unblock_input ();
5814 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5816 #endif
5818 if (! dpyinfo)
5819 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5820 else
5821 current_count +=
5822 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5823 current_hold_quit);
5825 else
5826 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5828 unblock_input ();
5830 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5831 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5833 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5835 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5838 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5839 enum xembed_message,
5840 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5842 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5844 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5845 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5846 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5848 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5850 static int
5851 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5852 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5854 union {
5855 struct input_event ie;
5856 struct selection_input_event sie;
5857 } inev;
5858 int count = 0;
5859 int do_help = 0;
5860 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5861 struct frame *f = NULL;
5862 struct coding_system coding;
5863 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5864 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5865 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5867 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5869 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5870 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5871 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5873 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5874 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5876 switch (event.type)
5878 case ClientMessage:
5880 if (event.xclient.message_type
5881 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5882 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5884 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5885 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5887 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5888 could be the shell widget window
5889 if the frame has no title bar. */
5890 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5891 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5892 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5893 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5894 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5895 #endif
5896 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5897 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5898 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5899 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5900 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5901 needed.
5903 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5904 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5905 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5906 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5907 Emacs. */
5909 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5910 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5911 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5912 if (f)
5914 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5915 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5916 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5917 x_catch_errors (d);
5918 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5919 /* The ICCCM says this is
5920 the only valid choice. */
5921 RevertToParent,
5922 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5923 /* This is needed to detect the error
5924 if there is an error. */
5925 XSync (d, False);
5926 x_uncatch_errors ();
5928 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5929 #endif /* 0 */
5930 goto done;
5933 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5934 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5936 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5937 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5938 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5939 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5940 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5941 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5942 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5943 session manager and one for this. */
5944 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5945 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5946 #endif
5948 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5949 event.xclient.window);
5950 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5951 for a single Emacs process. */
5952 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5953 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5954 event.xclient.window,
5955 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5956 else if (f)
5957 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5958 event.xclient.window,
5959 0, 0);
5961 goto done;
5964 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5965 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5967 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5968 event.xclient.window);
5969 if (!f)
5970 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5972 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5973 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5974 goto done;
5977 goto done;
5980 if (event.xclient.message_type
5981 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5983 goto done;
5986 if (event.xclient.message_type
5987 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5989 int new_x, new_y;
5990 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5992 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5993 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5995 if (f)
5997 f->left_pos = new_x;
5998 f->top_pos = new_y;
6000 goto done;
6003 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6004 if (event.xclient.message_type
6005 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6007 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6008 if (f)
6009 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6010 &event, NULL);
6011 goto done;
6013 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6015 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6017 || (event.xclient.message_type
6018 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6020 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6021 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6022 currently never do because we are interested in
6023 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6024 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6025 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6026 if (!f)
6027 goto OTHER;
6028 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6029 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6030 goto done;
6033 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6034 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6035 we construct an input_event. */
6036 if (event.xclient.message_type
6037 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6039 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6040 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6041 goto done;
6043 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6045 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6046 if (event.xclient.message_type
6047 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6049 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6050 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6051 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6053 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6054 goto done;
6057 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6059 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6060 if (!f)
6061 goto OTHER;
6062 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6063 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6065 break;
6067 case SelectionNotify:
6068 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6069 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6070 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6071 goto OTHER;
6072 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6073 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6074 break;
6076 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6077 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6078 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6079 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6080 goto OTHER;
6081 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6083 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6085 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6087 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6088 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6090 break;
6092 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6093 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6094 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6095 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6096 goto OTHER;
6097 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6099 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6101 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6106 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6109 break;
6111 case PropertyNotify:
6112 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6113 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6114 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6115 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty)
6116 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6117 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6119 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6120 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6121 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6122 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6123 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6124 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6125 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6126 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6127 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6130 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6131 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6132 goto OTHER;
6134 case ReparentNotify:
6135 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6136 if (f)
6138 int x, y;
6139 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6140 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6141 f->left_pos = x;
6142 f->top_pos = y;
6144 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6145 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6146 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6148 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6150 goto OTHER;
6152 case Expose:
6153 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6154 if (f)
6156 #ifdef USE_GTK
6157 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6158 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6159 event.xexpose.window,
6160 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6161 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6162 FALSE);
6163 #endif
6164 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6166 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6167 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6168 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6169 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6171 else
6172 expose_frame (f,
6173 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6174 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6176 else
6178 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6179 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6180 #endif
6181 #if defined USE_LUCID
6182 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6183 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6184 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6186 Widget widget
6187 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6188 if (widget)
6189 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6191 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6193 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6194 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6195 goto OTHER;
6196 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6197 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6198 event.xexpose.window);
6200 if (bar)
6201 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6203 else
6204 goto OTHER;
6205 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6206 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6208 break;
6210 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6211 source area was obscured or not
6212 available. */
6213 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6214 if (f)
6216 expose_frame (f,
6217 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6218 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6219 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6221 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6222 else
6223 goto OTHER;
6224 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6225 break;
6227 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6228 source area was completely
6229 available. */
6230 break;
6232 case UnmapNotify:
6233 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6234 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6236 tip_window = 0;
6237 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6240 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6241 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6242 the frame was deleted. */
6244 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6245 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6246 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6247 display that won't ever be seen. */
6248 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6249 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6250 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6251 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6252 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6253 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6254 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6255 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6257 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6258 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6259 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6262 goto OTHER;
6264 case MapNotify:
6265 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6266 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6267 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6268 goto OTHER;
6270 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6271 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6272 frame is visible. */
6273 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6274 if (f)
6276 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
6277 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6278 the frame's display structures.
6279 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6280 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6281 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6282 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6283 if (!iconified)
6284 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6286 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6287 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6288 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6289 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6291 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6292 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6293 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6295 if (iconified)
6297 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6298 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6300 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6301 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
6302 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
6303 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6305 #ifdef USE_GTK
6306 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6307 #endif
6309 goto OTHER;
6311 case KeyPress:
6313 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6314 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6316 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6317 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6318 if (popup_activated ())
6319 goto OTHER;
6320 #endif
6322 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6324 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6325 mouse highlighting. */
6326 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6327 && (f == 0
6328 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6330 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6331 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6334 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6335 if (f == 0)
6337 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6338 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6339 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6340 event.xkey.window);
6341 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6343 widget = XtParent (widget);
6344 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6347 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6349 if (f != 0)
6351 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6352 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6353 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6354 his Emacs hang.
6356 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6357 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6358 status_return even if the input is too long to
6359 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6360 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6361 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6362 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6363 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6364 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6365 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6366 int modifiers;
6367 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6368 Lisp_Object c;
6370 #ifdef USE_GTK
6371 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6372 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6373 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6374 (see above). */
6375 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6376 #endif
6378 event.xkey.state
6379 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6380 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6381 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6383 /* This will have to go some day... */
6385 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6386 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6387 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6388 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6389 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6390 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6391 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6393 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6394 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6395 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6396 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6397 not it is combined with Meta. */
6398 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6399 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6401 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6402 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6404 Status status_return;
6406 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6407 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6408 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6409 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6410 &status_return);
6411 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6413 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6414 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6415 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6416 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6417 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6418 &status_return);
6420 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6421 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6422 break;
6423 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6425 keysym = NoSymbol;
6426 modifiers = 0;
6428 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6429 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6430 emacs_abort ();
6432 else
6433 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6434 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6435 &compose_status);
6436 #else
6437 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6438 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6439 &compose_status);
6440 #endif
6442 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6443 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6444 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6445 break;
6447 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6448 orig_keysym = keysym;
6450 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6451 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6452 inev.ie.modifiers
6453 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6454 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6456 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6457 translations to characters. */
6458 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6459 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6461 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6462 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6463 goto done_keysym;
6466 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6467 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6469 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6470 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6471 else
6472 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6473 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6474 goto done_keysym;
6477 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6478 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6479 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6480 Vx_keysym_table,
6481 Qnil),
6482 NATNUMP (c)))
6484 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6485 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6486 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6487 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6488 goto done_keysym;
6491 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6492 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6493 || keysym == XK_Delete
6494 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6495 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6496 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6497 #endif
6498 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6499 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6500 #ifdef HPUX
6501 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6502 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6503 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6504 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6505 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6533 #endif
6534 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6535 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6536 #endif
6537 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6538 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6539 #endif
6540 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6541 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6542 #endif
6543 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6544 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6545 #endif
6546 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6547 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6548 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6549 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6550 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6551 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6552 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6553 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6554 don't have real modifiers but
6555 should be treated similarly to
6556 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6557 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6558 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6559 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6560 #endif
6563 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6564 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6565 key. */
6566 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6567 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6568 goto done_keysym;
6571 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6572 ptrdiff_t i;
6573 int nchars, len;
6575 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6577 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6578 nchars++;
6579 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6582 if (nchars < nbytes)
6584 /* Decode the input data. */
6586 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6587 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6588 we used just above and the locale. */
6589 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6590 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6591 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6592 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6593 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6594 gives us composition information. */
6595 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6597 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6598 nbytes);
6599 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6600 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6601 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6602 nbytes = coding.produced;
6603 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6604 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6607 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6608 character events. */
6609 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6611 int ch;
6612 if (nchars == nbytes)
6613 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6614 else
6615 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6616 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6617 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6618 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6619 inev.ie.code = ch;
6620 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6623 count += nchars;
6625 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6627 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6628 break;
6631 done_keysym:
6632 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6633 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6634 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6635 client. */
6636 break;
6637 #else
6638 goto OTHER;
6639 #endif
6641 case KeyRelease:
6642 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6643 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6644 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6645 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6646 client. */
6647 break;
6648 #else
6649 goto OTHER;
6650 #endif
6652 case EnterNotify:
6653 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6654 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6656 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6658 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6659 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6661 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6662 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6663 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6664 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6665 #ifdef USE_GTK
6666 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6667 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6668 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6669 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6670 #endif
6671 goto OTHER;
6673 case FocusIn:
6674 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6675 goto OTHER;
6677 case LeaveNotify:
6678 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6679 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6681 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6682 if (f)
6684 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6686 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6687 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6688 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6689 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6692 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6693 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6694 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6695 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6696 if (any_help_event_p)
6697 do_help = -1;
6699 #ifdef USE_GTK
6700 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6701 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6702 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6703 #endif
6704 goto OTHER;
6706 case FocusOut:
6707 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6708 goto OTHER;
6710 case MotionNotify:
6712 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6713 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6714 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6716 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6717 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6718 f = last_mouse_frame;
6719 else
6720 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6722 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6724 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6725 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6728 #ifdef USE_GTK
6729 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6730 f = 0;
6731 #endif
6732 if (f)
6735 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6736 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6737 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6739 Lisp_Object window;
6741 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6742 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6743 0, 0);
6745 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6746 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6747 will be selected only when it is active. */
6748 if (WINDOWP (window)
6749 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6750 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6751 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6752 create event iff we don't leave the
6753 selected frame. */
6754 && (focus_follows_mouse
6755 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6756 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6758 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6759 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6762 last_window=window;
6764 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6765 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6767 else
6769 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6770 struct scroll_bar *bar
6771 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6772 event.xmotion.window);
6774 if (bar)
6775 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6776 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6778 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6779 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6780 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6783 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6784 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6785 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6786 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6787 do_help = 1;
6788 goto OTHER;
6791 case ConfigureNotify:
6792 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6793 #ifdef USE_GTK
6794 if (!f
6795 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6796 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6798 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6799 event.xconfigure.height);
6800 f = 0;
6802 #endif
6803 if (f)
6805 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6806 #ifndef USE_GTK
6807 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6808 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6810 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6811 is called by the code that handles resizing
6812 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6814 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6815 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6816 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6817 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6818 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6819 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6820 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6822 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6823 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6824 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6827 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6828 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6829 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6830 #endif
6832 #ifdef USE_GTK
6833 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6834 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6835 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6836 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6837 #endif
6839 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6842 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6843 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6844 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6845 #endif
6848 goto OTHER;
6850 case ButtonRelease:
6851 case ButtonPress:
6853 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6854 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6855 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6857 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6858 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6859 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6861 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6862 && last_mouse_frame
6863 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6864 f = last_mouse_frame;
6865 else
6866 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6868 #ifdef USE_GTK
6869 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6870 f = 0;
6871 #endif
6872 if (f)
6874 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6875 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6876 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6878 Lisp_Object window;
6879 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6880 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6882 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6883 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6885 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6887 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6888 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6889 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6890 event.xbutton.state));
6894 if (!tool_bar_p)
6895 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6896 if (! popup_activated ())
6897 #endif
6899 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6901 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6902 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6904 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6905 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6907 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6908 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6910 else
6911 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6913 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6914 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6915 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6917 else
6919 struct scroll_bar *bar
6920 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6921 event.xbutton.window);
6923 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6924 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6925 scroll bars. */
6926 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6928 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6929 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6931 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6932 if (bar)
6933 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6934 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6937 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6939 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6940 last_mouse_frame = f;
6942 if (!tool_bar_p)
6943 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6945 else
6946 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6948 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6949 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6950 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6951 if (f != 0)
6952 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6954 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6955 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6956 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6957 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6958 Instead, save it away
6959 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6960 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6961 if (! popup_activated ()
6962 #ifdef USE_GTK
6963 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6964 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6965 #endif
6966 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6967 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6968 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6969 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6970 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6971 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6972 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6973 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6975 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6976 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6977 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6979 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6981 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6982 goto OTHER;
6984 else
6985 goto OTHER;
6986 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6988 break;
6990 case CirculateNotify:
6991 goto OTHER;
6993 case CirculateRequest:
6994 goto OTHER;
6996 case VisibilityNotify:
6997 goto OTHER;
6999 case MappingNotify:
7000 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7001 local cache. */
7002 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7004 case MappingModifier:
7005 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7006 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7007 case MappingKeyboard:
7008 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7010 goto OTHER;
7012 case DestroyNotify:
7013 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7014 break;
7016 default:
7017 OTHER:
7018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7019 block_input ();
7020 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7021 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7022 unblock_input ();
7023 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7024 break;
7027 done:
7028 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7030 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7031 count++;
7034 if (do_help
7035 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7037 Lisp_Object frame;
7039 if (f)
7040 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7041 else
7042 frame = Qnil;
7044 if (do_help > 0)
7046 any_help_event_p = 1;
7047 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7048 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7050 else
7052 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7053 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7055 count++;
7058 SAFE_FREE ();
7059 *eventptr = event;
7060 return count;
7063 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7065 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7066 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7067 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7069 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7071 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7073 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7074 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7076 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7078 if (dpyinfo)
7079 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7081 return finish;
7083 #endif
7086 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7087 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7089 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7090 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7091 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7092 C chars). */
7094 static int
7095 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7097 int count = 0;
7098 int event_found = 0;
7100 block_input ();
7102 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7103 input_signal_count++;
7105 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7106 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7108 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7109 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7112 #ifndef USE_GTK
7113 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7115 int finish;
7116 XEvent event;
7118 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7120 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7121 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7122 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7123 continue;
7124 #endif
7125 event_found = 1;
7127 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7128 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7130 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7131 goto out;
7134 out:;
7136 #else /* USE_GTK */
7138 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7139 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7140 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7141 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7143 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7144 from all displays. */
7146 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7148 current_count = count;
7149 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7151 gtk_main_iteration ();
7153 count = current_count;
7154 current_count = -1;
7155 current_hold_quit = 0;
7157 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7158 break;
7160 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7162 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7163 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7164 if (! event_found)
7166 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7167 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7168 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7169 x_noop_count++;
7170 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7172 x_noop_count=0;
7174 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7175 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7177 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7179 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7180 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7184 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7185 raise it now. */
7186 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7187 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7189 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7190 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7193 unblock_input ();
7195 return count;
7201 /***********************************************************************
7202 Text Cursor
7203 ***********************************************************************/
7205 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7206 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7208 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7209 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7210 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7212 static void
7213 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7215 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7216 XRectangle clip_rect;
7217 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7219 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7221 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7222 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7223 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7224 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7225 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7227 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7231 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7233 static void
7234 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7236 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7237 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7238 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7239 int x, y, wd, h;
7240 XGCValues xgcv;
7241 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7242 GC gc;
7244 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7245 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7246 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7247 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7248 return;
7250 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7251 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7252 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7254 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7255 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7256 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7257 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7258 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7259 else
7260 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7261 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7262 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7264 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7265 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7266 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7267 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7271 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7273 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7274 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7275 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7276 --gerd. */
7278 static void
7279 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7281 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7282 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7284 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7285 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7286 and mini-buffer. */
7287 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7288 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7289 return;
7291 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7292 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7293 the bar might not be in the window. */
7294 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7296 struct glyph_row *r;
7297 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7298 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7300 else
7302 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7303 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7304 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7305 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7306 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7307 XGCValues xgcv;
7309 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7310 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7311 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7312 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7313 that the glyph is legible. */
7314 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7315 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7316 else
7317 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7318 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7320 if (gc)
7321 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7322 else
7324 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7325 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7328 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7330 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7332 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7334 if (width < 0)
7335 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7336 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7338 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7340 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7341 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7342 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7343 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7345 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7346 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7347 width, row->height);
7349 else
7351 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7353 if (width < 0)
7354 width = row->height;
7356 width = min (row->height, width);
7358 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7359 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7361 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7362 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7363 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7364 row->height - width),
7365 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7368 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7373 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7375 static void
7376 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7378 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7379 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7380 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7381 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7385 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7387 static void
7388 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7390 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7391 x, y, width, height, False);
7392 #ifdef USE_GTK
7393 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7394 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7395 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7396 #endif
7400 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7402 static void
7403 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7405 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7407 if (on_p)
7409 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7410 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7412 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7413 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7414 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7415 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7417 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7418 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7420 else
7422 switch (cursor_type)
7424 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7425 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7426 break;
7428 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7429 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7430 break;
7432 case BAR_CURSOR:
7433 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7434 break;
7436 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7437 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7438 break;
7440 case NO_CURSOR:
7441 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7442 break;
7444 default:
7445 emacs_abort ();
7449 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7450 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7451 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7452 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7453 #endif
7456 #ifndef XFlush
7457 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7458 #endif
7462 /* Icons. */
7464 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7467 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7469 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7471 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7472 return 1;
7474 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7475 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7476 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7477 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7479 if (STRINGP (file))
7481 #ifdef USE_GTK
7482 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7483 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7484 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7485 return 0;
7486 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7487 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7488 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7490 else
7492 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7493 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7495 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7497 #ifdef USE_GTK
7499 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7500 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7501 return 0;
7503 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7505 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7506 if (rc != -1)
7507 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7509 #endif
7511 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7512 if (rc == -1)
7514 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7515 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7516 if (rc == -1)
7517 return 1;
7519 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7520 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7524 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7525 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7526 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7527 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7528 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7530 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7533 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7534 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7536 return 0;
7540 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7541 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7544 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7546 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7547 return 1;
7550 XTextProperty text;
7551 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7552 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7553 text.format = 8;
7554 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7555 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7558 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7559 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7560 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7561 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7563 return 0;
7566 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7568 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7569 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7571 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7572 be called from a signal handler.
7575 struct x_error_message_stack {
7576 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7577 Display *dpy;
7578 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7580 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7582 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7583 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7584 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7586 static void
7587 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7589 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7590 x_error_message->string,
7591 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7594 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7595 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7596 operating on.
7598 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7599 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7600 stored in *x_error_message.
7602 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7603 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7605 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7607 void
7608 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7610 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7612 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7613 XSync (dpy, False);
7615 data->dpy = dpy;
7616 data->string[0] = 0;
7617 data->prev = x_error_message;
7618 x_error_message = data;
7621 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7622 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7624 void
7625 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7627 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7629 block_input ();
7631 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7632 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7633 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7634 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7636 tmp = x_error_message;
7637 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7638 xfree (tmp);
7639 unblock_input ();
7642 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7643 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7644 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7646 void
7647 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7649 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7650 XSync (dpy, False);
7652 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7654 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7655 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7656 x_uncatch_errors ();
7657 error (format, string);
7661 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7662 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7665 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7667 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7668 XSync (dpy, False);
7670 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7673 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7675 void
7676 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7678 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7681 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7682 * idea. --lorentey */
7683 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7685 void
7686 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7688 while (x_error_message)
7689 x_uncatch_errors ();
7691 #endif
7693 #if 0
7694 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7695 x_trace_wire (void)
7697 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7699 #endif /* ! 0 */
7702 /************************************************************************
7703 Handling X errors
7704 ************************************************************************/
7706 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7708 static char *error_msg;
7710 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7711 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7713 static void
7714 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7717 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7718 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7720 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7721 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7723 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7724 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7726 if (dpyinfo)
7728 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7729 frame on it. */
7730 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7731 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7734 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7735 that are on the dead display. */
7736 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7738 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7739 minibuf_frame
7740 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7741 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7742 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7743 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7744 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7745 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7748 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7749 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7750 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7751 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7752 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7753 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7755 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7756 trying to find a replacement. */
7757 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7758 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7761 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7762 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7763 if (dpyinfo)
7765 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7766 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7767 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7768 #ifdef USE_GTK
7769 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7770 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7771 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7772 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7773 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7774 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7775 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7776 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7777 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7778 error_msg);
7779 emacs_abort ();
7780 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7782 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7783 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7785 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7786 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7787 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7788 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7789 emacs_abort ();
7792 Lisp_Object tmp;
7793 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7794 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7798 if (terminal_list == 0)
7800 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7801 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7802 /* NOTREACHED */
7805 totally_unblock_input ();
7807 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7808 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7810 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7811 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7813 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7814 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7815 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7816 error ("%s", error_msg);
7819 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7820 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7821 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7823 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7824 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7826 static int
7827 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7829 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
7830 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7831 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7832 && event->minor_code == 0)
7834 return 0;
7836 #endif
7838 if (x_error_message)
7839 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7840 else
7841 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7842 return 0;
7845 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7846 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7847 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7849 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7851 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7852 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7854 static void NO_INLINE
7855 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7857 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7859 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7860 or colors that are not defined. */
7862 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7863 return;
7865 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7866 original error handler. */
7868 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7869 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7870 buf, event->request_code);
7871 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7875 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7876 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7877 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7879 static int
7880 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7882 char buf[256];
7884 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7885 DisplayString (display));
7886 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7887 return 0;
7890 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7892 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7893 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7894 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7895 FONT-OBJECT. */
7897 Lisp_Object
7898 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7900 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7902 if (fontset < 0)
7903 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7904 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7905 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7906 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7907 do. */
7908 return font_object;
7910 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7911 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7912 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7913 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7915 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7917 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7918 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7920 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7921 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7922 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7924 else
7926 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7927 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7930 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7932 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7933 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7934 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7935 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7936 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7939 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7940 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7941 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7943 block_input ();
7944 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7945 unblock_input ();
7947 #endif
7949 return font_object;
7953 /***********************************************************************
7954 X Input Methods
7955 ***********************************************************************/
7957 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7959 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7961 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7962 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7963 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7965 static void
7966 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7968 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7969 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7971 block_input ();
7973 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7974 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7976 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7977 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7979 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7980 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7984 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7985 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7986 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7987 unblock_input ();
7990 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7992 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7993 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7994 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7995 #endif
7997 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7998 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8000 static void
8001 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8003 XIM xim;
8005 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8006 if (use_xim)
8008 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8009 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8010 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8011 emacs_class);
8012 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8014 if (xim)
8016 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8017 XIMCallback destroy;
8018 #endif
8020 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8021 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8023 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8024 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8025 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8026 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8027 #endif
8031 else
8032 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8033 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8037 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8039 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8040 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8041 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8042 when the callback was registered. */
8044 static void
8045 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8047 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8048 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8050 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8051 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8052 return;
8054 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8056 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8057 as they have no XIC. */
8058 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8060 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8062 block_input ();
8063 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8065 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8067 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8068 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8069 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8071 create_frame_xic (f);
8072 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8073 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8074 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8076 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8077 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8082 unblock_input ();
8086 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8089 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8090 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8091 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8092 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8094 static void
8095 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8097 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8098 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8099 if (use_xim)
8101 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8102 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8103 ptrdiff_t len;
8105 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8106 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8107 len = strlen (resource_name);
8108 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8109 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8110 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8111 resource_name, emacs_class,
8112 xim_instantiate_callback,
8113 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8114 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8115 least, hence the configure test. */
8116 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8117 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8118 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8119 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8121 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8125 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8127 static void
8128 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8130 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8131 if (use_xim)
8133 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8134 if (dpyinfo->display)
8135 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8136 NULL, emacs_class,
8137 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8138 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8139 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8140 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8141 if (dpyinfo->display)
8142 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8143 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8144 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8146 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8149 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8153 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8154 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8156 static void
8157 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8159 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8161 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8162 is already for the top-left corner. */
8163 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8164 return;
8166 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8167 position that fits on the screen. */
8168 if (flags & XNegative)
8169 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8170 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8173 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8175 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8176 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8177 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8179 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8180 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8181 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8182 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8183 is right, though.
8185 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8186 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8188 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8189 #endif
8191 if (flags & YNegative)
8192 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8193 - height + f->top_pos;
8196 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8197 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8198 so the flags should correspond. */
8199 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8202 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8203 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8204 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8205 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8206 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8208 void
8209 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8211 int modified_top, modified_left;
8213 if (change_gravity > 0)
8215 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8216 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8218 f->top_pos = yoff;
8219 f->left_pos = xoff;
8220 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8221 if (xoff < 0)
8222 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8223 if (yoff < 0)
8224 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8225 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8227 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8229 block_input ();
8230 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8232 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8233 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8235 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8237 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8238 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8239 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8240 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8241 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8244 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8245 modified_left, modified_top);
8247 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8248 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8249 ? 1 : 0);
8251 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8252 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8253 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8254 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8255 of the frame.
8257 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8258 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8259 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8261 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8262 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8263 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8264 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8265 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8266 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8268 unblock_input ();
8271 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8272 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8273 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8274 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8275 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8277 static int
8278 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8280 Atom actual_type;
8281 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8282 int i, rc, actual_format;
8283 Window wmcheck_window;
8284 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8285 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8286 long max_len = 65536;
8287 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8288 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8289 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8291 block_input ();
8293 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8294 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8295 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8296 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8297 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8298 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8300 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8302 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8303 x_uncatch_errors ();
8304 unblock_input ();
8305 return 0;
8308 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8309 XFree (tmp_data);
8311 /* Check if window exists. */
8312 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8313 x_sync (f);
8314 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8316 x_uncatch_errors ();
8317 unblock_input ();
8318 return 0;
8321 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8323 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8324 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8325 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8326 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8327 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8328 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8330 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8331 tmp_data = NULL;
8332 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8333 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8334 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8335 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8336 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8338 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8340 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8341 x_uncatch_errors ();
8342 unblock_input ();
8343 return 0;
8346 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8347 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8348 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8351 rc = 0;
8353 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8354 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8356 x_uncatch_errors ();
8357 unblock_input ();
8359 return rc;
8362 static void
8363 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8365 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8367 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8368 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8369 make_number (32),
8370 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8371 Fcons
8372 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8373 Fcons
8374 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8375 value != 0
8376 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8377 : Qnil)));
8380 void
8381 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8383 Lisp_Object frame;
8384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8386 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8388 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8389 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8392 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8393 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8394 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8396 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8398 static int
8399 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8400 Window window,
8401 int *size_state,
8402 int *sticky)
8404 Atom actual_type;
8405 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8406 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8407 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8408 long max_len = 65536;
8409 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8410 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8411 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8413 *sticky = 0;
8414 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8416 block_input ();
8417 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8418 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8419 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8420 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8421 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8423 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8425 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8426 x_uncatch_errors ();
8427 unblock_input ();
8428 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
8431 x_uncatch_errors ();
8433 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8435 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8436 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8438 is_hidden = 1;
8439 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8441 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8443 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8444 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8445 else
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8448 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8450 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8451 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8452 else
8453 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8455 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8456 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8457 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8458 *sticky = 1;
8461 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8462 unblock_input ();
8463 return ! is_hidden;
8466 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8468 static int
8469 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8471 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8472 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8473 int cur, dummy;
8475 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8477 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8478 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8479 if (!have_net_atom)
8480 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8482 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8484 Lisp_Object frame;
8486 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8488 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8489 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8490 are sent at once. */
8491 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8493 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8494 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8495 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8496 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8497 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8499 break;
8500 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8501 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8502 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8503 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8504 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8505 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8506 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8507 break;
8508 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8509 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8510 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8511 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8512 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8513 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8515 break;
8516 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8517 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8518 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8519 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8520 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8521 break;
8522 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8523 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8524 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8525 else
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8527 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8530 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8534 return have_net_atom;
8537 static void
8538 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8540 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8542 block_input ();
8543 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8544 x_sync (f);
8545 unblock_input ();
8550 static int
8551 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8553 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8554 Lisp_Object lval;
8555 int sticky = 0;
8556 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8558 lval = Qnil;
8559 switch (value)
8561 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8562 lval = Qfullwidth;
8563 break;
8564 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8565 lval = Qfullheight;
8566 break;
8567 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8568 lval = Qfullboth;
8569 break;
8570 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8571 lval = Qmaximized;
8572 break;
8575 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8576 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8578 return not_hidden;
8581 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8582 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8583 static void
8584 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8586 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8587 return;
8589 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8590 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8592 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8593 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8594 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8596 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8598 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8599 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8601 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8603 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8604 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8605 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8606 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8607 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8608 break;
8609 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8610 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8611 break;
8612 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8613 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8616 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8617 width, height);
8621 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8622 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8623 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8624 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8625 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8626 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8627 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8629 static void
8630 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8632 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8634 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8635 window manager window around the frame. */
8637 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8639 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8641 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8643 int adjusted_left;
8644 int adjusted_top;
8646 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8647 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8648 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8650 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8652 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8653 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8655 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8656 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8658 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8660 else
8661 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8662 frame's position. */
8664 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8668 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8669 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8670 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8671 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8672 of an exact comparison. */
8674 static void
8675 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8677 int count = 0;
8679 while (count++ < 50)
8681 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8683 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8684 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8685 loop. */
8687 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8688 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8690 if (fuzzy)
8692 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8693 pixels. */
8695 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8696 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8697 return;
8699 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8700 return;
8703 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8704 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8706 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8710 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8711 void
8712 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8714 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8716 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8717 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8718 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8720 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8721 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8723 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8724 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8725 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8726 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8728 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8730 pending_signals = 1;
8731 totally_unblock_input ();
8732 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8733 block_input ();
8734 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8736 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8737 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8739 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8740 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8741 break;
8743 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8744 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8745 break; /* Timeout */
8747 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8748 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8752 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8753 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8754 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8755 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8757 static void
8758 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8760 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8762 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8763 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8764 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8766 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8768 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8770 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8771 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8772 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8773 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8775 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8776 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8777 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8778 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8781 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8782 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8783 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8784 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8785 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8787 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8788 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8789 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8790 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8792 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8793 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8794 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8795 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8796 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8798 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8799 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8801 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8802 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8803 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8804 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8805 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8806 else
8808 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8809 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8810 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8811 x_sync (f);
8816 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8817 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8818 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8819 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8821 void
8822 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8824 block_input ();
8826 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8828 int r, c;
8830 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8831 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8832 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8833 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8834 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8835 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8836 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8837 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8838 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8839 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8840 is however. */
8841 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8842 #endif
8843 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8844 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8845 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8846 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8847 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8848 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8849 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8852 #ifdef USE_GTK
8853 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8854 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8855 else
8856 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8857 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8859 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8861 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8863 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8864 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8866 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8867 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8868 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8869 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8870 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8872 unblock_input ();
8875 /* Mouse warping. */
8877 void
8878 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8880 int pix_x, pix_y;
8882 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8883 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8885 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8886 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8888 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8889 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8891 block_input ();
8893 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8894 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8895 unblock_input ();
8898 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8900 void
8901 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8903 block_input ();
8905 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8906 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8907 unblock_input ();
8910 /* Raise frame F. */
8912 void
8913 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8915 block_input ();
8916 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8917 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8918 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8919 unblock_input ();
8922 /* Lower frame F. */
8924 static void
8925 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8927 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8929 block_input ();
8930 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8931 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8932 unblock_input ();
8936 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8938 void
8939 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8941 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8942 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8943 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8944 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8945 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8948 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8950 void
8951 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8953 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8954 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8956 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8958 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8960 Lisp_Object frame;
8961 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8962 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8963 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8964 make_number (32), list2i (1, last_user_time));
8968 static void
8969 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8971 if (raise_flag)
8972 x_raise_frame (f);
8973 else
8974 x_lower_frame (f);
8977 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8979 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8981 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8983 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8985 static void
8986 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8988 unsigned long data[2];
8989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8991 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8992 data[1] = flags;
8994 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8995 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8996 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8998 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9000 static void
9001 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9002 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9004 XEvent event;
9006 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9007 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9008 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9009 event.xclient.format = 32;
9010 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9011 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9012 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9013 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9014 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9016 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9017 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9018 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9021 /* Change of visibility. */
9023 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9024 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9025 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9026 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9027 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9028 finishes with it. */
9030 void
9031 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9033 Lisp_Object type;
9034 int original_top, original_left;
9035 int retry_count = 2;
9037 retry:
9039 block_input ();
9041 type = x_icon_type (f);
9042 if (!NILP (type))
9043 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9045 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9047 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9048 call x_set_offset a second time
9049 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9050 before the window gets really visible. */
9051 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9052 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9053 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9054 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9056 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9058 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9059 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9060 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9061 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9062 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9063 else
9065 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9066 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9068 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9069 #ifdef USE_GTK
9070 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9071 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9072 #else
9073 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9074 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9075 else
9076 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9077 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9078 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9081 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9083 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9084 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9085 so that incoming events are handled. */
9087 Lisp_Object frame;
9088 int count;
9089 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9090 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9091 will set it when they are handled. */
9092 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9094 original_left = f->left_pos;
9095 original_top = f->top_pos;
9097 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9098 unblock_input ();
9100 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9102 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9103 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9104 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9105 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9107 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9108 because the window manager may choose the position
9109 and we don't want to override it. */
9111 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9112 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9113 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9114 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9115 && previously_visible)
9117 Drawable rootw;
9118 int x, y;
9119 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9121 block_input ();
9123 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9124 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9125 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9126 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9127 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9128 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9129 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9130 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9131 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9133 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9134 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9135 original_left, original_top);
9137 unblock_input ();
9140 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9142 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9143 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9144 MapNotify at all.. */
9145 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9146 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9148 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9149 x_sync (f);
9151 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9152 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9153 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9154 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9155 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9156 probably a bug. */
9157 if (input_polling_used ())
9159 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9160 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9161 handler reset it. */
9162 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9163 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9164 poll_for_input_1 ();
9165 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9169 /* 2000-09-28: In
9171 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9172 (iconify-frame f)
9173 (raise-frame f))
9175 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9176 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9177 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9178 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9180 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9181 goto retry;
9185 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9187 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9189 void
9190 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9192 Window window;
9194 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9195 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9197 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9198 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9199 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9201 block_input ();
9203 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9204 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9205 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9206 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9207 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9208 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9210 #ifdef USE_GTK
9211 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9212 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9213 else
9214 #else
9215 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9216 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9217 else
9218 #endif
9221 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9222 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9224 unblock_input ();
9225 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9229 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9230 just by the event that we get from the server.
9231 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9232 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9233 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9234 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9235 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
9237 x_sync (f);
9239 unblock_input ();
9242 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9244 void
9245 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9247 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9248 int result;
9249 #endif
9250 Lisp_Object type;
9252 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9253 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9254 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9256 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9257 return;
9259 block_input ();
9261 type = x_icon_type (f);
9262 if (!NILP (type))
9263 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9265 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9266 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9268 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9269 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9271 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9272 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9273 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9274 unblock_input ();
9275 return;
9277 #endif
9279 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9281 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9283 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9284 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9285 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9286 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9287 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9288 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9289 so we have to record it here. */
9290 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9291 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9292 unblock_input ();
9293 return;
9296 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9297 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9298 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9299 unblock_input ();
9301 if (!result)
9302 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9304 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9305 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9307 block_input ();
9308 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9309 unblock_input ();
9310 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9312 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9313 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9314 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9315 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9316 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9317 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9319 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9320 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9322 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9323 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9325 XEvent msg;
9327 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9328 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9329 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9330 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9331 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9333 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9334 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9335 False,
9336 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9337 &msg))
9339 unblock_input ();
9340 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9344 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9345 IconicState. */
9346 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9348 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9350 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9351 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9354 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9355 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9357 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9358 unblock_input ();
9359 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9363 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9365 void
9366 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9368 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9369 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9370 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9371 Lisp_Object bar;
9372 struct scroll_bar *b;
9373 #endif
9375 block_input ();
9377 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9378 commands to the X server. */
9379 if (dpyinfo->display)
9381 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9382 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9383 face. */
9384 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9385 free_frame_faces (f);
9387 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9388 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9390 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9391 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9392 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9393 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9394 toolkit scroll bars. */
9395 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9397 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9398 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9400 #endif
9402 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9403 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9404 free_frame_xic (f);
9405 #endif
9407 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9408 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9410 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9411 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9413 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9414 we are using a toolkit. */
9415 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9416 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9418 free_frame_menubar (f);
9419 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9421 #ifdef USE_GTK
9422 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9423 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9425 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9426 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9427 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9429 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9430 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9431 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9432 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9433 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9434 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9436 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9438 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9439 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9440 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9441 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9442 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9443 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9444 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9445 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9446 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9447 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9449 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9452 x_free_gcs (f);
9453 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9456 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9457 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9458 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9460 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9461 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9462 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9463 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9464 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9465 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9467 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9469 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9470 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9471 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9472 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9473 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9474 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9477 unblock_input ();
9481 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9483 static void
9484 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9486 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9488 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9489 commands to the X server. */
9490 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9491 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9493 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9497 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9499 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9500 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9501 that the window now has.
9502 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9503 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9504 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9506 #ifndef USE_GTK
9507 void
9508 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9510 XSizeHints size_hints;
9511 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9513 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9514 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9516 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9517 return;
9519 #endif
9521 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9522 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9524 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9525 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9527 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9528 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9530 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9531 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9532 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9533 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9534 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9535 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9537 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9539 int base_width, base_height;
9540 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9542 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9543 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9545 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9547 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9548 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9549 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9550 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9551 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9553 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9554 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9555 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9557 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9558 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9559 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9560 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9561 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9564 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9565 if (flags)
9567 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9568 goto no_read;
9572 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9573 long supplied_return;
9574 int value;
9576 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9577 &supplied_return);
9579 if (flags)
9580 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9581 else
9583 if (value == 0)
9584 hints.flags = 0;
9585 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9586 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9587 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9588 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9589 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9590 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9591 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9592 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9596 no_read:
9598 #ifdef PWinGravity
9599 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9600 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9602 if (user_position)
9604 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9605 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9607 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9609 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9611 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9613 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9615 static void
9616 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9618 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9619 Arg al[1];
9621 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9622 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9623 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9624 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9626 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9627 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9629 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9630 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9633 static void
9634 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9636 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9638 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9639 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9640 #endif
9642 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9644 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9645 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9646 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9647 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9649 else
9651 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9652 pixmap. */
9653 return;
9657 #ifdef USE_GTK
9659 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9660 return;
9663 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9666 Arg al[1];
9667 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9668 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9669 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9670 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9673 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9675 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9676 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9678 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9681 void
9682 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9684 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9686 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9687 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9688 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9690 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9694 /***********************************************************************
9695 Fonts
9696 ***********************************************************************/
9698 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9700 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9701 font table. */
9703 static void
9704 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9706 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9707 if (font->driver->check)
9708 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9711 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9714 /***********************************************************************
9715 Initialization
9716 ***********************************************************************/
9718 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9719 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9720 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9721 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9723 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9724 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9725 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9727 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9728 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9729 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9730 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9731 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9732 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9733 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9736 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9738 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9740 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9742 static int x_initialized;
9744 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9745 the screen number from the server number. */
9746 static int
9747 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9749 int seen_colon = 0;
9750 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9751 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9752 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9754 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9755 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9756 length_until_period++;
9758 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9759 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9760 name1 += 4;
9761 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9762 name2 += 4;
9763 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9764 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9765 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9766 name1 += system_name_length;
9767 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9768 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9769 name2 += system_name_length;
9770 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9771 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9772 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9773 name1 += length_until_period;
9774 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9775 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9776 name2 += length_until_period;
9778 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9780 if (*name1 == ':')
9781 seen_colon = 1;
9782 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9783 return 1;
9785 return (seen_colon
9786 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9787 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9790 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9791 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9792 to 5. */
9793 static void
9794 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9796 int nr = 0;
9797 int off = 0;
9799 while (!(mask & 1))
9801 off++;
9802 mask >>= 1;
9805 while (mask & 1)
9807 nr++;
9808 mask >>= 1;
9811 *offset = off;
9812 *bits = nr;
9815 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9816 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9819 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9821 int dpy_ok = 1;
9822 Display *dpy;
9824 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9825 if (dpy)
9826 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9827 else
9828 dpy_ok = 0;
9829 return dpy_ok;
9832 #ifdef USE_GTK
9833 static void
9834 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9835 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9837 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9838 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9840 #endif
9842 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9843 the structure that describes the open display.
9844 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9846 struct x_display_info *
9847 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9849 int connection;
9850 Display *dpy;
9851 struct terminal *terminal;
9852 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9853 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9854 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9855 ptrdiff_t lim;
9857 block_input ();
9859 if (!x_initialized)
9861 x_initialize ();
9862 ++x_initialized;
9865 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9866 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9868 #ifdef USE_GTK
9870 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9871 int argc;
9872 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9873 char **argv2 = argv;
9874 guint id;
9876 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9878 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9880 else
9882 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9883 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9885 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9886 argv[argc] = 0;
9888 argc = 0;
9889 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9891 if (! NILP (display_name))
9893 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9894 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9897 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9898 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9900 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9902 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9903 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9904 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9906 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9907 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9908 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9909 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9911 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9912 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9913 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9915 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9916 fixup_locale ();
9917 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9918 fixup_locale ();
9920 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9922 xg_initialize ();
9924 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9926 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
9927 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9929 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9930 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9932 s = build_string (file);
9933 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9935 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9936 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9938 #endif
9940 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9941 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9944 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9945 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9946 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9947 errors with X11R5:
9948 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9949 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9950 So let's not use it until R6. */
9951 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9952 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9953 #endif
9956 int argc = 0;
9957 char *argv[3];
9959 argv[0] = "";
9960 argc = 1;
9961 if (xrm_option)
9963 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9964 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9966 turn_on_atimers (0);
9967 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9968 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9969 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9970 &argc, argv);
9971 turn_on_atimers (1);
9973 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9974 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9975 fixup_locale ();
9976 #endif
9979 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9980 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9981 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9982 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9983 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9985 /* Detect failure. */
9986 if (dpy == 0)
9988 unblock_input ();
9989 return 0;
9992 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9994 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9995 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9997 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10000 struct x_display_info *share;
10001 Lisp_Object tail;
10003 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10004 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10005 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10006 SSDATA (display_name)))
10007 break;
10008 if (share)
10009 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10010 else
10012 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10013 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10014 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10016 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10017 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10018 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10019 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10020 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10022 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10024 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10026 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10027 list of terminals. */
10028 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10029 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10030 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10031 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10033 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10034 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10035 unblock_input ();
10036 kset_system_key_alist
10037 (terminal->kboard,
10038 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10039 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10040 block_input ();
10041 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10042 terminal_list = terminal;
10043 UNGCPRO;
10046 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10047 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10048 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10049 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10050 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10052 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10055 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10056 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10057 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10059 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10060 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10061 x_display_name_list);
10062 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10064 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10066 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10067 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10068 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10069 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10071 #if 0
10072 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10073 #endif /* ! 0 */
10075 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10076 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10077 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10078 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10079 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10080 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10081 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10083 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10084 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10086 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10087 #ifdef USE_GTK
10088 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10089 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10090 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10092 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10093 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10095 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10096 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10097 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10098 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10099 #else
10100 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10101 #endif
10102 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10103 all versions. */
10104 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10106 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10107 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10108 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10109 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10110 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10111 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10112 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10113 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10115 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10118 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10119 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10120 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10129 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10130 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10131 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10134 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10135 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10136 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10138 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10140 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10141 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10142 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10143 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10144 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10145 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10148 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10149 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10151 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10153 Lisp_Object value;
10154 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10155 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10156 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10157 Qnil, Qnil);
10158 if (STRINGP (value)
10159 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10160 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10161 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10164 else
10165 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10166 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10168 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10170 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10171 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10172 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10173 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10174 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10175 for example). */
10176 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10177 double d;
10178 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10179 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10181 #endif
10183 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10185 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10186 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10187 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10188 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10189 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10190 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10191 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10192 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10193 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10197 static const struct
10199 const char *name;
10200 int offset;
10201 } atom_refs[] = {
10202 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
10203 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
10204 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols)
10205 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus)
10206 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
10207 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window)
10208 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state)
10209 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
10210 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved)
10211 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader)
10212 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres)
10213 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD)
10214 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP)
10215 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT)
10216 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT)
10217 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING)
10218 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE)
10219 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE)
10220 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR)
10221 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP)
10222 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS)
10223 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL)
10224 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM)
10225 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR)
10226 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER)
10227 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO)
10228 /* For properties of font. */
10229 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE)
10230 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH)
10231 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET)
10232 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE)
10233 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT)
10234 /* Ghostscript support. */
10235 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE)
10236 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE)
10237 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar)
10238 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED)
10239 /* EWMH */
10240 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state)
10241 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
10242 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10243 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
10244 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10245 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
10246 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
10247 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
10248 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type)
10249 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10250 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip)
10251 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name)
10252 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name)
10253 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported)
10254 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check)
10255 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity)
10256 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window)
10257 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents)
10258 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop)
10259 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea)
10260 /* Session management */
10261 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID)
10262 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop)
10263 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr)
10266 int i;
10267 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10268 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10269 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10270 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10271 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10272 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10273 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10274 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10276 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10277 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10279 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10280 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10281 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10282 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10284 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10285 False, atoms_return);
10287 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10288 *(Atom *) ((char *) dpyinfo + atom_refs[i].offset) = atoms_return[i];
10290 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10291 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10293 xfree (atom_names);
10294 xfree (atoms_return);
10297 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10298 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10299 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10300 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10302 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10303 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10304 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10306 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10307 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10308 dpyinfo->gray
10309 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10310 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10311 1, 0, 1);
10313 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10314 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10315 #endif
10317 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10319 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10320 if (connection != 0)
10321 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10323 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10324 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10325 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10327 if (interrupt_input)
10328 init_sigio (connection);
10330 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10332 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10333 Font font;
10335 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10336 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10337 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10338 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10339 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10340 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10341 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10342 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10343 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10344 emacs_abort ();
10345 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10346 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10347 x_uncatch_errors ();
10349 #endif
10351 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10352 for debugging X code. */
10354 Lisp_Object value;
10355 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10356 build_string ("synchronous"),
10357 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10358 Qnil, Qnil);
10359 if (STRINGP (value)
10360 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10361 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10362 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10366 Lisp_Object value;
10367 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10368 build_string ("useXIM"),
10369 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10370 Qnil, Qnil);
10371 #ifdef USE_XIM
10372 if (STRINGP (value)
10373 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10374 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10375 use_xim = 0;
10376 #else
10377 if (STRINGP (value)
10378 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10379 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10380 use_xim = 1;
10381 #endif
10384 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10385 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10386 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10387 tty. */
10388 if (terminal->id == 1)
10389 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10390 #endif
10392 unblock_input ();
10394 return dpyinfo;
10397 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10398 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10400 static void
10401 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10403 struct terminal *t;
10405 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10406 X display. */
10407 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10408 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10410 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10411 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10412 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10413 x_session_close ();
10414 #endif
10415 delete_terminal (t);
10416 break;
10419 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10421 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10422 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10423 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10424 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10425 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10426 else
10428 Lisp_Object tail;
10430 tail = x_display_name_list;
10431 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10433 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10435 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10436 break;
10438 tail = XCDR (tail);
10442 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10443 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10445 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10446 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10447 else
10449 struct x_display_info *tail;
10451 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10452 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10453 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10459 xfree (dpyinfo);
10462 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10464 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10465 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10466 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10467 that slows us down. */
10469 static void
10470 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10472 block_input ();
10473 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10474 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10476 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10477 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10478 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10479 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10481 unblock_input ();
10484 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10485 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10486 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10487 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10488 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10489 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10490 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10492 void
10493 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10495 block_input ();
10496 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10498 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10499 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10500 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10502 unblock_input ();
10505 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10508 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10510 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10512 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10513 x_produce_glyphs,
10514 x_write_glyphs,
10515 x_insert_glyphs,
10516 x_clear_end_of_line,
10517 x_scroll_run,
10518 x_after_update_window_line,
10519 x_update_window_begin,
10520 x_update_window_end,
10521 x_cursor_to,
10522 x_flush,
10523 #ifdef XFlush
10524 x_flush,
10525 #else
10526 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10527 #endif
10528 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10529 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10530 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10531 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10532 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10533 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10534 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10535 x_draw_glyph_string,
10536 x_define_frame_cursor,
10537 x_clear_frame_area,
10538 x_draw_window_cursor,
10539 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10540 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10544 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10545 void
10546 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10548 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10550 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10551 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10552 if (!terminal->name)
10553 return;
10555 block_input ();
10556 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10557 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10558 X display. */
10559 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10560 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10561 #endif
10563 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10564 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10565 if (dpyinfo->display)
10567 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10568 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10570 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10571 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10572 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10573 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10575 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10576 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10577 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10578 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10579 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10580 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10581 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10582 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10583 leaks in other situations. */
10584 #if 0
10585 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10586 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10587 #else
10588 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10589 #endif
10590 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10591 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10592 closing all the displays. */
10593 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10594 #endif
10596 #ifdef USE_GTK
10597 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10598 #else
10599 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10600 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10601 #else
10602 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10603 #endif
10604 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10607 /* Mark as dead. */
10608 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10609 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10610 unblock_input ();
10613 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10614 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10616 static struct terminal *
10617 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10619 struct terminal *terminal;
10621 terminal = create_terminal ();
10623 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10624 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10625 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10627 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10629 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10630 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10631 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10632 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10633 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10634 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10635 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10636 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10637 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10638 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10639 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10640 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10641 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10642 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10643 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10644 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10645 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10646 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10647 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10648 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10650 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10651 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10653 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10654 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10655 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10656 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10657 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10658 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10659 off the bottom. */
10661 return terminal;
10664 void
10665 x_initialize (void)
10667 baud_rate = 19200;
10669 x_noop_count = 0;
10670 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10671 any_help_event_p = 0;
10672 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10674 #ifdef USE_GTK
10675 current_count = -1;
10676 #endif
10678 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10679 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10681 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10682 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10684 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10686 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10687 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10688 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10689 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10690 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10691 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10692 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10694 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10695 #endif
10697 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10698 #ifndef USE_GTK
10699 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10700 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10701 #endif
10702 #endif
10704 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10705 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10706 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10708 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10709 original error handler. */
10710 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10711 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10715 void
10716 syms_of_xterm (void)
10718 x_error_message = NULL;
10720 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10721 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10723 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10724 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10726 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10727 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10729 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10730 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10732 #ifdef USE_GTK
10733 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10734 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10736 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10737 #endif
10739 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10740 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10741 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10742 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10743 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10744 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10745 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10746 sizes. */);
10747 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10749 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10750 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10751 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10752 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10753 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10754 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10755 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10757 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10758 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10759 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10760 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10761 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10762 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10763 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10764 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10765 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10767 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10768 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10769 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10770 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10771 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10772 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10774 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10775 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10776 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10777 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10778 #elif USE_GTK
10779 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10780 #else
10781 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10782 #endif
10783 #else
10784 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10785 #endif
10787 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10788 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10790 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10791 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10792 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10793 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10794 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10795 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10796 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10797 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10798 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10800 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10801 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10802 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10803 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10804 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10805 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10807 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10808 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10809 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10810 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10811 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10812 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10814 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10815 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10816 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10817 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10818 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10819 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10821 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10822 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10823 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10824 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10825 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10826 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10828 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10829 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10830 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10831 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10832 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10833 Qnil);
10836 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */